Survey
* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project
JOURNAL THE AMERICAN COLLEGE OF TRUST AND ESTATE COUNSEL 3415 S. Sepulveda Boulevard, Suite 330 • Los Angeles, California 90034 • (310) 398-1888 • FAX: (310) 572-7280 Louis A. Mezzullo, Editor / Beverly R. Budin, Assistant Editor / © The American College of Trust and Estate Counsel 2002 Table of Contents Volume 28, No. 2, Fall 2002 President’s Message . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 Editor’s Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 The 2002 Annual Joseph Trachtman Memorial Lecture: Some Thoughts on Philanthropy and Net Worth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .77 William H. Gates, Sr. Hackl Debacle: Are the Annual Exclusion and Discounts Mutually Exclusive for Gifts of Closely-Held Business Interests? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .83 Jerome A. Deener This article analyzes the recent Hackl decision and recommends ways to avoid loss of annual exclusions for gifts of limited partner/limited liability interests. Adversity After Bosch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .88 Shirley L. Kovar This article discusses how the Bosch decision and its progeny affect the ability of taxpayers to settle controversies as to the meaning of wills and trusts and to correct mistakes in such documents without adverse tax consequences. Punctilio of an Honor—A Trustee’s Duties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .101 Robert J. Rosepink This article provides a comprehensive review of the duties of a trustee, including commentary on the Uniform Trust Code and Restatement of the Law (Second) of Trusts. Total Return Unitrusts: Is This a Solution in Search of a Problem? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .121 Alvin J. Golden This article critiques the total return unitrust concept and offers alternative solutions to the mandatory income trust. Washington Report . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150 John M. Bixler and Ronald D. Aucutt Foundation News . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153 John A. Wallace Spotlight on Attorneys’ Fees . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155 Martin A. Heckscher New Developments in Construction and Instruction Case Law . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157 John F. Meck ACTech Talk: Tips for Technophobes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 Robert B. Fleming New Developments in Malpractice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Keith Bradoc Gallant and Sharon B. Gardner Calendar of Events; In Memoriam . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .C1 28 ACTEC Journal 73 (2002) President’s Message by Carlyn S. McCaffrey New York, New York The practice of trusts and estates law seems to many of us to be one of the most enjoyable and rewarding practice areas in the legal profession. Those of us who practice in this area enjoy the challenge of problem solving, the pleasure of meeting and working with a wide variety of individual clients, the reward of establishing long-term relationships with many of them, and the satisfaction of helping them make informed and educated decisions about matters of great importance to them and to their families. For the past 52 years, ACTEC has been an organization of trusts and estates lawyers recognized for its commitment to excellence in the trusts and estates field. Membership in ACTEC gives each of us an opportunity to enjoy the company and dialogue of experienced trusts and estates lawyers from across the country, each of whom is keenly interested in the development of the legal rules that are the tools of our practice. That interest spurs us not only to master those rules and to retain that mastery through the constant process of legislative, judicial and regulatory changes but also, when appropriate, to play a role in the development of those changes. ACTEC provides us with several forums, real and virtual, for sharing our professional experiences, including our national meetings, which take place three times each year. The most recent one was held in Tucson in October at the La Paloma Resort. More than 610 of you and your guests attended. Based on the comments I heard from those of you who were there, all of you had an enjoyable and stimulating experience. We had two full mornings of professional seminars, our usual challenging committee meetings, a chance to socialize at two outdoor parties, and an opportunity to enjoy the beautiful desert and mountains that surround the resort. Our next annual meeting will take place at El Conquistador Resort in Puerto Rico from March 5 through March 10. A preliminary schedule and a hotel reservation form, along with a cover letter, were mailed to you on October 25. I hope to see many of you there. Regional and state meetings provide additional opportunities for learning from each other. These are 28 ACTEC Journal 74 (2002) particularly helpful for those of you who are unable to attend our national meetings. Each region, and many individual states, have at least one meeting each year, often with a format that follows our national meetings’ familiar mix of learning and social opportunities. Check with your state chair or with the national office to find out when your next regional or state meeting will be held. ACTEC has two virtual forums—our list services and our Web site. All of us can take advantage of these forums on a daily basis. There are two major list services open to all members of the College, ACTECGEN and ACTEC-PRAC. ACTEC-GEN allows us to share recent developments affecting our practice and to ask for help with particular problems. ACTEC-PRAC is devoted to practice issues. To find out more about the list services, go to the private side of the ACTEC Web site, left click on the “Email and Discussion Forums” button on the left hand side of the page and follow the instructions. The Web site is full of interesting, helpful resources. All of the issues of the ACTEC Journal, from Fall 1994 through the present, can be accessed by left clicking the “College Publications” button on the left hand side of the Web site page. You can search by key words and phrases through all of the issues from Winter 1995 through the current issue. For example, a search for “Bosch” will refer you to eight different articles that mention that case. When you access an article that cites Bosch, another search will help you locate the references within the article to the Bosch case. Bill Crawford, our systems administrator, has been working to enhance the Web versions of the Journal articles by including (to the greatest extent possible) links to online texts of cases mentioned in the articles. Take a look at any of the articles in this issue of the Journal to see what this feature is about. Other materials available under the College Publications button include ACTEC’s Commentaries on the Model Rules, ACTEC’s forms of engagement letters, and ACTEC’s studies of state laws. We’ve recently expanded the scope of the materials available on the site by adding CLE materials from recent national meetings. All of the outlines prepared for the national meetings from 1999 through the present are now accessible on the site. Those of you who need more shelf space can discard your blue meeting binders and rely on the Web for access to these important materials. Web access to CLE materials that are two or more years old is free to all ACTEC members. CLE materials from more recent meetings are available free to those members who attended the meetings and are available at a small charge to all other members. Finally, there are the links. Left click on the “Toolbox & Topical Links” button, and you’ll find a wonderful array of links to outside resources as well as to materials produced by College committees and members. ACTEC’s Web site is the result of many years of hard work by College members and staff, including Stan Foster and Joe Hodges, who dragged the College into the computer age in the early days when many of us lacked the foresight to understand what an important tool it would be. More recent contributors include our tireless systems administrator, Bill Crawford, and our Web Oversight Group members, Don Kelley, Bjarne Johnson, and Bob Kunes. We owe them all a deep debt of gratitude. ACTEC’s future as the preeminent association of trusts and estates attorneys requires a continuing flow of new members. We are counting on each of you to help identify prospective new members within your community. We are looking for experienced and capa- ble trusts and estates lawyers whose commitment to our field has manifested itself in their writings, lectures and bar association activities. When you’re considering likely candidates, keep in mind that ACTEC admits not only attorneys whose practice is centered on estate and transfer tax planning and probate practice, but also those who focus on fiduciary litigation, elder law, and employee benefits and charitable planning for individuals. Each of these practice areas adds to the richness of the ACTEC experience. ACTEC’s national Membership Selection Committee will consider the admission of new members at its meeting at ACTEC’s annual meeting in March in Puerto Rico. If you have a candidate to suggest, please complete the nomination form and send it to your state chair no later than January 3, 2003. A nomination form and a copy of the Requirements and Procedures for the Election of Fellows were sent to you in the October 25 mailing. You may also print out the nomination form from ACTEC’s Web site or request one from the College’s office. [Signature] 28 ACTEC Journal 75 (2002) Editor’s Page by Louis A. Mezzullo Richmond, Virginia The contents of this issue reflect several trends that I hope continue in the future. First, we have excellent articles on very relevant topics. Second, we have a number of articles on nontax subjects. While the Trachtman Lecture given by Bill Gates, Sr. deals with some aspects of the repeal of the estate and generation skipping transfer taxes, it is also a commentary on philanthropy in our country. For those of you who were not fortunate enough to hear Mr. Gates’ lecture in La Quinta, you will find his remarks not only interesting, but also very meaningful to the Fellows and the role we play in helping our clients dispose of their wealth in a responsible manner. We are fortunate to have two articles dealing with nontax aspects of trusts. Bob Rosepink’s comprehensive discussion of the duties of trustees, which is an updated version of the outline provided in connection with the program that he and Bob Goldman presented at the Annual Meeting in La Quinta, is must reading for Fellows who serve as or advise trustees. We also are fortunate to have Al Golden’s discussion on total return trusts, taking a somewhat contrarian view to that popular concept. Again, Al’s article is an update of the materials submitted for the program that he and Bob Wolf presented at the Annual Meeting on total return trusts. [An earlier version of Bob’s article on the same topic appeared in ACTEC Notes in 1997.] Both of these articles will be of great practical use by all Fellows. Shirley Kovar’s article on adversity after Bosch does deal with tax issues, specifically the effect of state law on federal transfer tax issues. Finally, Jerry Deener provides us with insights about the effects of the Tax Court’s holding in the Hackl case. 28 ACTEC Journal 76 (2002) So far, I have not received any comments from the Fellows concerning the suggestions that Beverly Budin and I proposed for improving the Journal. However, the Editorial Board will be considering permanently adopting the criteria Beverly drafted concerning submission of articles for publication in the Journal. In addition, the practice of assigning editors for proposed articles has proven to be very successful, with the author and editor working together to provide a better product. For example, Jere McGaffey provided suggestions for Jerry Deener’s article. Please let us know if you are willing to serve as an editor of articles on a particular topic. For those of you who have already sent the last issue to storage, I am repeating the guidelines that Beverly drafted for accepting articles for publication: 1. Content. The basic criterion for an article’s publication in the ACTEC Journal is that the article makes a contribution to the literature of trusts and estates, and is not a regurgitation of material readily available elsewhere. The following kinds of material meet the content criterion: a. Original analysis: i. Particular area of the law. ii. Particular case, regulation, ruling, etc. b. Practical approach to problem, including drafting techniques. c. Comprehensive review of area of the law (Example: comparison of the law in different states). d. Summary/analysis of area related to estates and trusts (Example: article on hedge funds). e. Review of literature in the area. 2. Quality of writing. Material should be wellorganized and well-written. The 2002 Annual Joseph Trachtman Memorial Lecture: Some Thoughts on Philanthropy and Net Worth by William H. Gates, Sr. Seattle, Washington* I have to admit that I was pleased when I learned that my conversation with you today was being billed as a lecture. You see, as the father of two daughters and a son, I’ve had more than a few occasions to give lectures. Those lectures were reasonably well attended, particularly if they took place where food was being served. However, one of my children, my son, Bill acquired the rather irritating habit of reading during my lectures. That’s right, he read, most every night at the dinner table! Of course, the alternative was worse—if there was a full moon or he was feeling argumentative, it was like being back in court. I can’t say that I noticed then that he particularly had a “legal” mind, although I feel confident in saying that he does now. But you know, as I think of that, I’m sure that many lawyers dream of having a firm where they have their name on the door and where their son comes to work every day. I, on the other hand, go to an office every day where my son never comes to work and his name’s on the door. So this has been a long way around of saying that I’m enthused about the prospect of giving a lecture that might finally be listened to. It’s like coming home to be in a room mostly full of attorneys. A large part of my life has been spent with the law. My work involved in part doing the same things you do, helping solve the same complex and thoroughly human puzzles, and I found great satisfaction in that. Now I have a second career. It came to me unbidden and quite unexpected. When my son and his wife decided to establish their foundation, they asked me if I’d help and I said “yes.” So instead of booking cruises to the Galapagos or sitting on a beach in Hawaii, I’m spending my “golden years” traveling to places like Bangladesh and Mozambique. In those places, I’ve watched dedicated medical people working in remote clinics and crowded city hospitals administering lifesaving vaccines and other medical therapies to the world’s children. Looking back, my experience with volunteering and philanthropy and the law was valuable—but insufficient—preparation for my second career. I had no idea how difficult the cause of improving global health could be, or how important it is to succeed. Still, in hindsight, I know my “yes” to Bill and Melinda was a good decision. I’ve had an opportunity to meet people who are living gallant lives under the most difficult circumstances imaginable, to see their countries with new understanding and to see my own country—and the concept of philanthropy—with fresh eyes. My remarks today will be colored by all those experiences. I have only a few answers, and many questions. There are many ambiguities and some seeming contradictions I have observed. I can confirm, for example, that Americans, as individuals, are—as expected— among the most generous peoples on Earth. Oxford University, for example, raises more money in the United States than it does in the United Kingdom. But I’ve also discovered that America, as a nation, is surprisingly parsimonious. In 1999, the latest year for which figures are available, we gave only 0.1 percent of our gross national product to official foreign development, a budget category that excludes defense and that includes items I think of as helping provide poor nations with an opportunity to improve their situation. Denmark gave 10 times that, Japan and Germany about 3 times that amount and Portugal gave 31 ⁄2 times as much. I have a table that lists 23 nations in this world in order of their relative contributions to poor countries; the United States ranks 23rd. Another example of those ambiguities and contradictions I’ve observed is that I know beyond any doubt that our society offers more choices, greater freedoms, richer opportunities and greater protections to its citizens than most other countries. But I also have learned how easy it is to take all that for granted, to imagine our unique society as a given—a birthright of sorts—and to suppose that it is cheap to maintain. * The 2002 Joseph Trachtman Memorial Lecture was presented at the 2002 ACTEC Annual Meeting in La Quinta, California, on March 1, 2002. Copyright 2002. William H. Gates, Sr. All rights reserved. William H. Gates, Sr., is the Co-chair and CEO of the Bill & Melinda Gates Foundation. 28 ACTEC Journal 77 (2002) Searching for clarity in the face of these disconnects, I’ve looked at the history of philanthropy, and I’ve concluded that giving to others is central to our nature. I believe that we extend help to each other partly for reasons that are altruistic and spiritual in nature. I also suspect that the impulse toward social behavior and helping one another may be hard-wired into our species—a key to our survival. Social scientists speculate that evolution is less a story of the fittest having survived than it is of the cooperation and nurturing from others that allowed them to do so. Think of our distant ancestors who found themselves in a wilderness, frail compared with the wild creatures around them with neither fang nor claw, but possessing two other gifts that proved even better, that is, communication and cooperation. I remember hearing once that teams of paleontologists, working in Kenya with Dr. Richard Leakey studying the migration patterns of early primates, observed what they thought were indications of those very human characteristics. They said they knew they were looking at a different kind of creature when they found bones that had been broken and then given the opportunity to heal. They said this indicated that when a member of this species was injured, he or she had not been left behind to die. Instead others had stayed to tend to and protect the injured members, until he was physically able to move on. They saw that as a sign of caring and cooperation that was not in evidence among the bones of other primates. In the book The Fragile Species, Dr. Lewis Thomas, a former chairman of the Department of Pathology and dean at Yale Medical School, wrote, “it goes too far to say that we have genes for liking each other, but we tend in that direction because of being a biologically social species. We are more compulsively social, more interdependent and more inextricably attached to each other than any of the celebrated social insects.” Whatever the reasons for it, it’s clear that humans were social animals, from the beginning, who could reason and act together to achieve common goals. Over time, we used those powers to build complex social structures and systems. Many of those early institutions formalized the social imperative. Governments levied taxes to pay for security, permit trade and assure continuity. And, even in the most ancient civilizations there were individual mechanisms created through which people provided private support to the widowed, aged and orphaned. Religions introduced the concept of tithing—suggesting that a portion of what is ours should be set aside for community needs. Well, there are various forms of tithing being encouraged in the secular realm, today. There’s a relatively new organization in Min- 28 ACTEC Journal 78 (2002) nesota called the One Percent Club. It encourages people to give one per cent of their net worth each year to charitable causes. There’s also a fellow named Claud Rosenberg who’s promoted a standard he calls “the new tithing,” aimed at getting the well-to-do to substantially increase their levels of giving. He doesn’t suggest a set percentage. His system uses a table, which sets forth income on one axis and investment assets on the other. Where your income line meets your investment assets line is the suggested new tithing amount. So both tithing and taxes have historically given us the means to accomplish together things we could not have accomplished alone. Another of those interesting contradictions I cited earlier that I’ve observed is that in modern times—in the United States, where the concept of private ownership of property is nourished and highly valued—so is the concept of the common good. In fact, the French social observer Alexis de Tocqueville wrote about those conflicting values way back in the 1830s. Evidence of our concern for the common good is in the fact that Americans invented many associations and mechanisms for giving including the United Way concept, which is now being adopted in other places around the world while it is being passed down to a new generation of Americans. There’s been some apprehension in donor circles as to whether or not the young “techies” who have recently earned wealth would become significant charitable givers. My observation is that they’re definitely picking up where their parents left off, and they’re doing more than their share. United Way is a typical example. In Seattle, we have a Million Dollar Roundtable that was just started a few years ago. The minimum gift is a million dollars. The club now has 47 members, including many young entrepreneurs. These young people are also creating new mechanisms for giving. We have one in our area called Social Venture Partners, the express purpose of which is to move technology wealth toward good causes. Of course, as counselors, you deal with individuals who have accumulated considerable wealth—and if your experience is similar to mine, you seldom, if ever, find yourselves creating an interest in charitable bequests where no such inclination already existed. On the other hand, in my practice, I was surprised by the number of instances when, in discussing a will, the interest in some charitable giving was expressed, without, however, any particular conviction about what that charitable giving should be. So counselors have an opportunity to provide some input and counsel that is very constructive. I have also had the experience of being asked to evaluate some cause or direction in which the client has expressed an initial interest. In that case, the sophisticated counselor can perform a service of great value to a donor who, at least initially, wishes to remain anonymous. Frequently clients are looking to add funds to an existing endowment or foundation. Here, the counselor has a heavy responsibility to understand how endowments work and to become well informed about that which has the client’s interest. Such things as the statement of purposes, investment policies, rate of payout, power to invade and power to amend are items the client needs to be informed about. And then there is, always, the “perpetual” question. Forever is really quite a long time. If you want to have some fun with idle speculation try and think about what people might be doing with the billions of dollars that exist in endowment funds, today and 1,000 years from now in 3002. All of which asks, very loudly, how long should one commit funds when the ultimate use of them is unknown? Should the plan include the forever time element? This is a question still being asked in our family. Anyone who spends any appreciable time counseling in this area should be aware that there is wide and constructive literature discussing these kinds of questions in considerable detail. The counselor could do well to read some of this work and would surely find some clients who would relish doing some reading of their own. And of course, this leads directly to the subject of the family foundation. Family foundations fall into two broad categories. One of those I call the improvement category. It’s characterized by interests that one might call general good citizen types of support, such as helping build a new symphony hall or helping contribute to some other community enterprise. The other category I call the reform category. If your client is interested in this category then he or she has cut out a piece of work to do. More on that in a moment. In this regard, I think you will find interesting the approach Warren Buffet has in mind for the long-term management of his foundation. His scheme is one in which there are never more than a very few trustees. He believes that foundations should be devoted to reform, which requires boldness. His conviction is that a large board is unlikely to act with the requisite boldness. As long as we are talking about foundations, let’s talk for a moment about the Bill & Melinda Gates Foundation and my experience with it over the period of the last six or seven years. We clearly started in the improvement category. We had no particular goals in mind. In our case, that may not have been critical because the benefactor was and is still very much alive to give direction. Any foundation of appreciable size needs to be fairly clear about what its interests are and similarly clear about the fact it is not going to spend time considering projects outside of those interests. We spent time responding to a lot of proposals that might never have come in, had we been clearer about our goals from the start. Let me share some of the requests we received. We got a letter from a guy who wanted us to fund a ballroom dancing TV channel. He thought if everybody in this country learned the same steps, then people on the East coast could dance with people on the West coast. We could solve a lot of society’s problems, if we just got everybody dancing! Then there was the guy who wanted us to help him jump his funny car over the Grand Canyon. And speaking of natural wonders, we got a request from a guy who had clearly become anxious watching the Discovery Channel. He wrote, urgently asking us if we would mind “venting” the so-called magma chamber of the Yellowstone volcano. He said, “I know this is going to take ‘big bucks.’ But then you have those.” A major directional shift occurred for us when Bill and Melinda read an article in The New York Times about the number of people around the world, especially children, still dying of diseases that have long been eradicated in this country. As a result of that and their trips over seas, they became concerned about the problem of global health. As Bill and Melinda’s enthusiasm for global health grew, they made a series of very substantial additions to the corpus of the foundation. Our venture into global health provides the perfect example of what I meant when I said that if you were beginning to consider giving that fell into the category of reform, you needed to realize you’re getting into a very involved project. You have to prepare for a process of trial and error, for extensive study and for hiring experts. Because now the problem becomes one of analysis and insight: What is the cause of this problem? What can be done, by whom, to effectively change the etiology? Now my son has started reading everything he can find on the subject of global health. Fortunately he’s not reading quite as much as he used to at the dinner table. Because with such book titles as The Coming Plague and Overcoming Microbial Resistance, his reading selections are becoming increasingly unappetizing. They say that the fellow who articulated the initial strategy for John D. Rockefeller’s philanthropy, Frederick Gates, read a thousand books in the process. I believe it. On the subject of global health, in one of his books the historian Arnold Toynbee predicted that the 20th century would be seen as the age where it became pos- 28 ACTEC Journal 79 (2002) sible for the whole world to have good health. But he was overly optimistic. In the poorest places of the world today, especially in the tropics, the average life span is 47 years of age and dropping. With AIDS, in some places it’s dropping down into the 30s. The 600,000 women who die each year of pregnancy-related causes may not even live that long. That’s right. Although the risk in the United States of a mother dying in childbirth or of pregnancy-related causes is only one in 3,500, in India, it’s one in 37. In Africa, it’s one in 16. One hundred fifty million children are deficient in vitamin A. This deficiency, when complicated by diseases like measles, leaves half a million of them blind and costs another one to two million their lives. People in the developing world are still dying from ancient ills such as malaria and tuberculosis. One and a half million die each year from a form of tuberculosis which can be cured for as little as $20. Three million children a year die from illnesses that vaccines prevent our children from ever experiencing. Of course, statistics get at the breadth of the problem, but not its human impact. In order to communicate impact, I have to ask you a question: “Is the loss of a child less tragic in one place on the planet than another?” I think we would like to think that, but it is not true. I think it also gives one some perspective to realize that just a century ago, children in New York City were dying of some of the same ailments that take the lives of children of the developing world today. Now, whether one’s cause is the health of the world’s children, or any other cause in philanthropy, there’s never enough money to go around. So at our foundation, we try to find the things that we can afford to do that will have the greatest impact. In global health, the bulk of our work falls under the category of prevention, which is something vaccines accomplish so efficiently. For many diseases one administration of a vaccine can protect a child for a lifetime. Prevention is also the focus of our work in the fight against AIDS. And we’re into something called “micronutrients.” They prevent illnesses and deaths caused by a lack, for example, of vitamin A, or iodine. There have been enormous improvements made to the lives of children already through the use of micronutrients. As daunting as all those statistics are, very positive changes have already been achieved in every one of the areas that I’ve mentioned by, in many cases, a handful of people with their hearts in the right place. Even in recent history we have seen some remarkable progress: • there are countries like Kenya and Thailand where the birth rate has been reduced to nearly the reproduction rate, meaning that the population simply 28 ACTEC Journal 80 (2002) replaces itself from generation to generation; • we managed to eliminate smallpox from the world a couple decades ago and we are within a couple of years of completely eliminating polio; • the new tetanus vaccine has drastically reduced deaths from this killer, which took 200,000 lives four years ago. We know that those accomplishments have been made possible largely by the achievements of those who came before us. The Rockefellers, for example, have been supporting the study of diseases such as the ones I’ve mentioned today for as far back as 100 years. In fact, they played a leadership role in establishing medical research as a full time pursuit rather than something physicians did in their free time. And in terms of philanthropy in general, they, the Carnegies and others of that era are credited with changing philanthropy from an endeavor that simply responded to human suffering to one that attempted to eliminate the root causes of that suffering. They found the causes. They changed the etiology. They eliminated the problem. They succeeded at reform. These people I’ve mentioned and so many more realized long before we did that there are huge gaps that exist between the way that we live and the way the poor people of the world live. That’s why, as we talk today about wealth and the sharing of it, it’s important to reflect on where wealth comes from. If one wants to become wealthy, being smart helps. Being energetic and lucky play a role. But as Warren Buffet suggests, probably the most important piece of luck a person can have is to win what he calls “the ovarian lottery”: being born in this country. Let me tell you a fable that this point. The story begins where God is perplexed. He has a problem to solve. His problem is that his total assets have been in serious decline and he needs to pump up his bottom line. So He calls two about-to-be-born fetuses into his office. And he explains to them the fact that he has sort of a financial problem and he’s going to need some input of capital over time. He’s figured out the way to do it, and it’s this: “I have one spot in the United States, and one spot in another part of the world,” he says. “I’m going to auction off the United States spot. I’m going to hand each of you a piece of paper. I want you to write down on it the percentage of your net worth that you’re willing to leave to my treasury when you die. And the one of you who writes down the highest number is going to be born in the United States.” Do you think either of them would be so stupid as to write down a number as low as 55 percent? My point is, what is it worth to be an American? Now I speak for myself on a personal note and not as an official of the Foundation. One of the things that rankles me about our national discourse around the repeal of the estate tax is how thoroughly we ignore the criticality of the place of birth. I’ve always liked thinking that when we make a gift we are giving something of benefit back to someone or something that benefited us. I think most people grasp that concept when they make a contribution to their college or university. They sense they owe something to the institution that made a contribution to their lives, an institution nurtured and subsidized by others. It’s a very obvious connection. And this is why so very many people with high net worth make large gifts to their colleges. What’s not always as readily seen by these folks is that they owe a debt to a system that goes far beyond that university, and without which that university wouldn’t even exist: our American system. That system has provided them with security, public education, law enforcement, a working court system, an orderly economy with orderly markets, and the ability to expect that basic conditions tomorrow and the next year will be pretty much as they are today. Any American entrepreneur would do well to reflect on the influence that things like patent protections, enforceable contracts, limited liability systems, property records and so many other legal guarantees of our system might have had on his ability to run a viable business and make a profit. The accumulation of large net worth is much more a product of the order that exists in this wonderful place than it is a product of personal talent and effort. I believe that not only provides the rationale for a system of estate taxation, but also is indeed the principle that makes the repeal of estate taxation an affront to rational public policy. People who have been able to spend a large portion of their lives with virtually unlimited discretion about what they buy, where they go, how they get there, are indeed very privileged persons. Consider with me for just a moment the pleasure and convenience that attends having enough money to own and travel in your own jet airplane. Now compare that to the sometimes exhaustive planning, crowds, delays and security restrictions confronting the bulk of Americans who must fly commercially. Should a society, through its Congress, guarantee a person who has known such extraordinary privilege, who has been able to exercise his discretion about almost every element of living, the ability to pass on, at the end of his life, free of any public impost, all of the power to live in that manner to his or her offspring? That question leads to another important principle. Leon Bostein, president of Bard College and conductor of the American Symphony Orchestra, suggests that throughout the 20th century, Americans tolerated inequalities in wealth because there was a partial trans- fer of wealth from private hands to the public sector that happened with the passing of each generation. He goes on to say that the dream of rags to riches has been sustained as believable, in part, because of the dilution of wealth at death. Teddy Roosevelt, in promoting the estate tax in 1907 wrote: “Our aim is to realize what Lincoln pointed out: the fact that there are some respects in which men are obviously not equal; but also, to insist that there should be an equality of self respect and of mutual respect, an equality before the law, and at least an approximate equality in the conditions under which each man obtains the chance to show the stuff that is in him when compared to his fellows.” It’s also been said that, in defending the Constitution, James Madison admitted that he believed the overriding purpose of government was to protect the unequal acquisition of property. There are just two goals for America: 1) a prosperous society, and 2) a just society. We have succeeded with number one. We are a long way from, and losing ground, in achieving number two. Warren Buffet compares the repeal of the estate tax with choosing the 2020 Olympic team by naming the eldest sons of the gold medal winners in the 2000 Olympics—ridiculous. Oh, we hear talk about how the repeal of the estate tax puts family farms and small family companies out of business. But an Iowa state economist named Neil Harl, whose job it is to know these things, said that he had searched far and wide and found the demise of family farms due to the estate tax to be a myth. The tax reform act of 1997 went a long way towards addressing the estate planning needs of family-owned farms and businesses. I think we may need to fix certain aspects of the estate tax by strengthening family enterprise protections and raising individual exemptions, but I do not believe that we should repeal it. What will the repeal of the estate tax cost us? The estate tax currently brings in revenue—some $28 billion dollars in 1999. That’s about the same amount as what the government spends for housing and urban development. And the dollar cost of repealing the estate tax is only going to become greater as the greatest transfer of wealth in history begins to occur. Last year the poorest person on the Forbes magazine list of our country’s 400 richest citizens had a net worth of $725 million. When this list originated in 1982 the net worth of number 400 was $75 million. Just think what those numbers imply for estate tax collections over the next decade or two. Recognize that under those 400 fortunate, there is this huge pyramid of extremely wealthy individuals. How many $50 millionaires would you suppose? And there is another point made by this prodigious 28 ACTEC Journal 81 (2002) growth in the number of people who are really wealthy. We can readily increase exemptions dramatically. These were $225,000 in 1982 and are now just $1 million. Larger exemptions and some tinkering with special provisions should largely release the difficulties in giving closely held businesses to children. Some level of taxation is a requirement if government is to provide whatever level of services is agreed upon. If the estate tax is removed, then something, no doubt higher income tax rates, will be required to provide those services. There is no free lunch. Right here, I’d like to take a moment to highlight the connection between the social achievements we accomplish through our system of government and those which we pursue privately, through the medium of philanthropy. Achieving the social goals deemed in keeping with a civil society has required and will continue to require the joint efforts of both private philanthropy and public entities. They play complementary roles. Something we’ve seen in our own philanthropy is that if private giving can demonstrate that a particular undertaking is achievable, governments will very often follow this lead and commit resources to it. John D. Rockefeller, for example, observed that our country’s medical education standards were not up to par with those of Europe. And he initiated a successful effort to change that, an effort that was ultimately embraced and pursued by our government. Private philanthropists and volunteers have initiated reform movements such as civil rights and women’s rights, and the environmental movement, all of which were ultimately taken up by government. Conversely, government often launches endeavors that philanthropy then begins to support. For example, right now in global health, our foundation is, in many cases, carrying forward decades of hard work done by government agencies such as USAID and the World Health Organization. In the domestic arena, an example that comes to my mind is the enormous amount of basic scientific research our government has supported that has not only stimulated so much private enterprise, but that has been continually used to solve painful human problems that touch the lives of every one of our families. For instance who but government would have, 20 or 30 years ago, supported an obscure medical research scientist at the University of Washington who wanted to study how baker’s yeast cells divide, a researcher who just recently, this past December, carried away a Nobel Prize. 28 ACTEC Journal 82 (2002) That scientist, Dr. Lee Hartwell, now director of the Fred Hutchinson Cancer Research Center in Seattle, an institution I and others support, was cited as having provided pioneering work in the field of cancer research. Dr. Hartwell and his work wouldn’t be there for individual citizens to support through private philanthropy if it weren’t for the sustained support he was given by our government. His example speaks not only to the role government plays in serving the common good but also to the role it plays in giving individuals inclined toward high achievement the encouragement and sustenance they need to succeed. And so you see, in my view, all these elements that define the American condition, that condition that resides at the very heart of our ability to live the way we do, are indeed community resources. Community resources that include both assets that are the investments of government and assets that are a product of philanthropy. It is this condition, the American condition, that made possible Dr. Hartwell’s Nobel Prize, and put young Bill Gates and his 399 friends on the Forbes 400. Now, I know not all of us picture the world just this way. And so not everyone would agree with me. But that’s another one of the extraordinary characteristics of our American system: it provides a climate for debate and dissent that allows us to air issues like this one in a way that leads us to further reflection and ultimately yields improvements. I made a comment earlier about an observation made by paleontologists who worked in Kenya with Dr. Richard Leakey, studying the remains of our ancient ancestors. Now I’d like to mention an observation made by Richard Leakey’s wife, Dr. Mary Leakey. She said in studying ancient sediments and the actual footprints of early humans she had often in those footsteps detected a sign of hesitation. She said it happened enough to convince her that from the very beginning, doubt had been built into our species. I like to think that her observation suggests the prehistoric existence of an attribute Harry Truman said was an essential quality of any American president and Mark Twain called “the surest sign of intelligence”: an open mind. As long as Americans and our American system go on prizing that quality, I believe that in similar manner to those who left those ancient footprints, we may never fully arrive, but we will be ever journeying forward, consistently advancing in the direction of a more just society. Hackl Debacle: Are the Annual Exclusion and Discounts Mutually Exclusive for Gifts of Closely-Held Business Interests? by Jerome A. Deener* Hackensack, New Jersey Despite the Internal Revenue Service's attempts to ignore the family limited partnership or limited liability company in its entirety, or to reduce discounts by arguing the applicability of Sections 2703 or 2704, the courts continue to uphold the validity of these entities, and recognize that discounts are appropriate. See, e.g., Strangi, 115 T.C. 478 (2000)(31%); Knight, 115 T.C. 506 (2000)(15%); Jones, 116 T.C. 121 (2001)(8%/44%); Church, unpublished (5th Cir. 7/18/2001)(63%); Adams, 2001-2 U.S.T.C. Par. 60,418 (N.D. Tex. 2001)(54%); Dailey, 82 T.C.M. 70 (2001)(40%). The viability of the taxpayer's business appraisal is an important aspect of substantiating the appropriate discount. To achieve the discount, the partnership agreement should be carefully drafted to include restrictions upon limited partners' rights to partnership assets. The following types of provisions generally contained in a limited partnership agreement or a limited liability company operating agreement can favorably impact the discount available for the limited partnership or membership interests: (1) restrictions on sale or other transfer; (2) restrictions on ability to dissolve the entity; (3) restrictions on rights to withdraw capital; and (4) discretion vested solely in the general partner/manager to distribute income. The discount is often supported by an appraiser's opinion. The appraiser will consider the various restrictions in the agreement, and relevant capital market evidence, when rendering an opinion. Impact of Restrictions on Annual Exclusion. Under the recent Tax Court case of Hackl v. Comm'r, 118 T. C. No. 14 (3/27/02), an LLC containing these restrictions caused the loss of the annual exclusion for gifts of membership interests. The tension between the availability of discounts and the qualification for the annual exclusion is explored in this article. The Hackl decision may significantly affect the availability of the gift tax annual exclusion for gifts of interests in closely-held businesses. In that case, the Tax Court disallowed the annual exclusion for gifts of limited liability membership interests because it deter* Copyright 2002. Jerome A. Deener. All rights reserved. mined that they were not "present interests," finding that the donees did not have the immediate benefit of the property received. The very restrictions that created the valuation discount caused the court to disallow the annual exclusion. HACKL FACTS. In December 1995, father and mother formed a limited liability company ("LLC") under Indiana state law to conduct a new family business, consisting of tree farming operations. This involved the purchase of land with little or no existing timber, because it was significantly cheaper, and because their goal was longterm growth. Father purchased land and contributed it to the LLC. Subsequently, father and mother contributed cash and securities to the LLC. In exchange for their contributions, father and mother received voting and non-voting membership units in the LLC. The LLC operating agreement provided that management of the LLC business was "exclusively vested in the manager," that such manager "shall perform [his] duties in good faith, in a manner … reasonably believed to be in the best interests of the company" and with the care of "an ordinarily prudent person." Thus, a standard for the manager's decision making was established. Father was named as the initial manager for life, or until his resignation, removal or incapacity. The operating agreement also provided that the manager controlled the distributions of cash. Further, the agreement provided that no member had a right to withdraw his capital contribution, except with the manager's approval, and that the members waived the right to have LLC property partitioned. No member could withdraw from the LLC without prior consent of the manager. However, a member could offer his units to the LLC, with the manager having complete authority to accept or reject the offer and negotiate the terms. No member could transfer his units, except with the manager's consent, which could be withheld as the manager determined in his sole discretion. Members did have the following rights: to vote on removal and replacement of the manager by majority vote; to amend the operating agreement by an 80% majority vote; to access the LLC books and records; to decide to continue the business after an event of disso- 28 ACTEC Journal 83 (2002) lution; and, after father was no longer the manager, to vote to dissolve the LLC by an 80% majority vote. The stated purpose of the business was to acquire and manage the properties for long-term income and appreciation, rather than to produce immediate income. In fact, the taxpayers anticipated that the LLC would operate at a loss for a number of years. Therefore, they did not expect the LLC to make any distributions to members during those years. In fact, the LLC reported losses for 1995 through 1998. The LLC never generated any profits nor made any distributions of cash or other property. Within a month of formation of the LLC, father and mother made gifts of voting and non-voting units to their eight children and their respective spouses. In March of 1996, father and mother made similar gifts to the children and children-in-law, and also made gifts of units to trusts for the benefit of their 25 grandchildren. All of the gifts were reported on timely-filed gift tax returns and annual exclusions were claimed for all the gifts. The annual exclusions for gifts on the 1995 and 1996 tax returns were disallowed by the IRS, and were the subject of this case. The valuation discount was stipulated (although its magnitude was not revealed), and was not an issue in the opinion. ANALYSIS BY TAX COURT. Review of the Law. To qualify for the gift tax annual exclusion under Code Section 2503(a), the gift must be of a "present interest." The regulations under Section 2503 define a present interest in part as "an unrestricted right to the immediate use, possession, or enjoyment of property or the income from property (such as a life estate or term certain) …" . The taxpayers argued that the gifts of membership interests were outright gifts of a present interest, equal to the bundle of property rights conferred by the LLC membership interests. The IRS argued that the restrictions in the operating agreement were insufficient to confer the necessary immediate rights. The Tax Court first agreed with the taxpayers that the "property" at issue here is the LLC unit, rather than an indirect gift of the underlying LLC property represented by that unit ("an ownership interest in the entity itself, rather than an indirect gift in property contributed to the entity"). The court recognized that the LLC was duly organized under state law as an LLC, the units of which are "personal property separate and distinct from the LLC's assets." These conclusions apparently were intended to clarify issues that the IRS has brought up in recent cases on the discounts for limited partnership interests. The Tax Court then held that the body of case law 28 ACTEC Journal 84 (2002) involving indirect gifts, usually through trusts, was also applicable here. These cases have held that a present interest only exists where the donee receives a substantial present economic benefit. Thus, where the use, possession, or enjoyment is postponed until a contingent or future event occurs, such as the exercise of discretion by a trustee or joint action of the interest holders, or where there is no history of a steady flow of cash from the trust or entity, the gift has not qualified as a present interest. The timing of the rights, as well as the existence of the rights, is relevant. Therefore, the Tax Court rejected the idea that the mere fact that a gift was made outright qualifies it for the annual exclusion, without any analysis of the benefits conferred thereby. Although the Tax Court held that the indirect gift cases are "the relevant body of Federal authority," it is difficult to see their relevance once it has been accepted that the gifted property is the LLC unit and not the LLC's underlying assets. The donee's rights to the underlying assets or income therefrom should not be the criteria to judge enjoyment of the LLC unit. Nevertheless, the Tax Court concluded that, to qualify for the annual exclusion, the law requires that the donee receive "an unrestricted and noncontingent right to the immediate use, possession, or enjoyment (1) of property or (2) of income from property, both of which alternatives in turn demand that such immediate use, possession, or enjoyment be of a nature that substantial economic benefit is derived therefrom." Note that this is a disjunctive test, and so the right can be to the property or to the income therefrom. APPLICATION TO FACTS OF HACKL CASE. As to Property Rights. The LLC operating agreement was considered to be most relevant in determining the rights conferred by the units. The restrictive agreement was found to deny the members "the ability to presently access any substantial economic or financial benefit that might be represented by the ownership units." The court found that the lack of rights discussed above (namely, (1) no withdrawal rights, except as approved by manager; (2) no rights to transfer units, except with consent of manager (which consent was totally discretionary); (3) no dissolution rights; and (4) "put" right, subject to manager negotiation of terms) meant that some contingency (generally, the consent of the manger) prevented a member from receiving the economic benefit of his property. The court summarily dismissed the argument that the right of a donee to assign his interest constituted a present interest: the possibility of making sales in vio- lation [of manager approval], to a transferee who would then have no right to become a member or to participate in the business, can hardly be seen as a sufficient source of substantial economic benefit. However, it is not clear why the ability of a donee to confer assignee status on a third party was insufficient to constitute a "present interest." Although an assignee interest is worth less than a full membership interest, it is still a property right with value to the purchaser and immediate economic benefit to the seller. As to Income Distributions. The member had no right to the income from the units, because income was unlikely to be received in the near future, and distributions were discretionary with the manager. The court said that a three-pronged income test must be satisfied: (1) that the entity will receive income; (2) that some portion of the income will flow steadily to the holder of the interest; and (3) that the portion of the income flowing to the interest holder can be ascertained. Because the business goal was for long-term income and appreciation, and specifically not for immediate income, the court found that even the first part of the income test had not been met. Moreover, even if there had been a history of income earned, no income would be distributed to the members unless the manager exercised his discretion. Since the timing and amount of any distributions were speculative, the court found that no current economic benefit of the income from the property was received by the donees. It appears that, even if income were actually earned and distributed by the partnership, the court would not find the requisite current economic benefit of the income because under the agreement the distributions were discretionary with the manager. The court did not clearly address the relevance of a fiduciary standard upon the manager's discretion. As indicated above, the manager was required to act in the best interests of the company and with the care of an ordinarily prudent person. In two relatively recent Technical Advice Memoranda, however, the existence of a fiduciary standard seemed to be a key factor in allowing the annual exclusion. In TAM 9751003, which dealt with the identical issue of whether the annual exclusion was available for gifts of limited partnership interests, the Internal Revenue Service focused on the lack of a fiduciary standard in the partnership agreement, where the general partner had complete discretion over the distribution of income and could retain income "for any reason whatsoever." The Internal Revenue Service held that this provision eliminated the fiduciary duty normally imposed on a general partner and gave him the authority to withhold income for reasons unrelated to the partnership. The TAM did not disclose the amount of cash flow or whether distributions were actually made. The Internal Revenue Service applied the same tests as the Tax Court later used in Hackl, and concluded that, since it was uncertain at the time of the gifts whether any income would be distributed to the limited partners, the income test failed. Therefore, the limited partnership interests did not qualify for the annual exclusion. Although the partnership in the TAM owned income-producing commercial real estate, as well as other realty, the Internal Revenue Service did not focus on the entity's ability to distribute income in reaching its conclusion. In TAM 199944003, the Internal Revenue Service again addressed the issue of the annual exclusion for gifts of limited partnership interests. Again, the timing and amount of any distribution of income was in the sole discretion of the general partner. However, in this situation, where the partnership agreement specifically imposed a "strict fiduciary duty toward the limited partners and the partnership," the Internal Revenue Service distinguished the cases where a trustee has total discretion over distributions. Instead, it pointed out that the general partner's powers were consistent with those possessed in most limited partnerships and those granted under state law. Moreover, due to the fiduciary standard imposed under the agreement, the limited partners "may expect the highest standard of conduct from the general partners in their management of the partnership." Accordingly, the gifts qualified for the annual exclusion. The TAM did not discuss the type of assets held by the partnership or the cash flow therefrom. In each TAM, there were also restrictions on the limited partners' rights to transfer their interests, withdraw from the partnership and withdraw capital contributions. In the first TAM discussed above, the Internal Revenue Service concluded that these restrictions precluded the economic benefits required for a present interest. However, in the more recent TAM, the limited partners' rights were deemed to entitle the donees to current economic benefits. Since the main distinction between the facts in the TAMs was the lack of a fiduciary duty in the first case, that would seem to be the relevant focus. However, the Tax Court did not discuss whether the language of the Hackl agreement imposed a sufficient fiduciary duty on the manager. Therefore, contrary to the conclusion derived from a close reading of the TAMs, under the Hackl case, the imposition of a fiduciary standard on the discretion of the manager/general partner appears to be insufficient to create a present economic benefit of the income. PLANNING RECOMMENDATIONS. First, although the Hackl case involved an LLC, it should be pointed out that the court's analysis would 28 ACTEC Journal 85 (2002) apply equally to family limited partnerships and to closely-held S and C corporations. This case turns primarily on the lack of income-producing objectives, total discretion in making income distributions, as well as the near total control by the manager, and the very restrictive operating agreement provisions on transfers and withdrawals of capital. The type of assets held by the LLC in Hackl were not currently income producing and were specifically not intended to produce income for quite some time. Since the Hackl test is disjunctive (i.e., a right to the property or the income therefrom), an entity holding securities or income-producing real estate should be viewed differently than one holding non-incomeproducing assets, such as vacant land for which development is not planned for quite some time. Also, a partnership that has a history of distributions should be viewed differently than one that never distributed cash flow. However, the decision appears to indicate that for an income-producing entity, the mere actual distribution of income is insufficient, and the entity agreement must be drafted to require a distribution of income (or a portion thereof). Thus, the recommendations are different for income-producing entities and non-income producing entities. Also, the planner and client should focus on the ultimate objective of the planning. If the planning is to gift (or sell) at a discount a significant portion of the units (for example, to use the client's gift tax exemption equivalent), the use of the greatest permissible legal restrictions will be helpful to achieve the highest discount possible. The Hackl decision implicitly embraces the usual taxpayers' arguments that a significant discount should apply to a limited partnership interest with restrictions. On the other hand, if the client will merely be giving annual exclusion amounts each year, then the restrictions should be tailored to obtain a discount while still qualifying for a present interest within the Hackl parameters. In dealing with the recommendations, the attorney should be careful to discuss with a qualified business appraiser, in advance, how the restrictions (or lack thereof) would affect the discount. A draft of the entity agreement should be submitted to the appraiser in advance for comment. 1. For an entity with marketable securities or other income-producing property, clients with existing entities should be advised to make pro rata distributions of income, at least equal to the income taxes that the members will pay on the entity income. In addition, the entity agreement should state that the distribution of income is in the discretion of the manager/general partner, but that at least a certain percent of net income (e.g., 45% of taxable income, which should be sufficient to cover the partners' 28 ACTEC Journal 86 (2002) income taxes on their pro rata share of income) must be distributed annually. The right to receive a stated percentage of income may be sufficient, without further removal of other restrictions, to produce the required present economic benefit to sustain the annual exclusion. For an entity with a low yield on marketable securities, for example, the requirement to distribute 45% of net income should have a minimal impact, if any, on the discounts. However, if the entity has significant cash flow relative to its asset value, the negative impact on discounts could be large. For instance, in a partnership with a steady income stream, a 50% partner's interest was denied a minority discount. See Godley, 80 T.C.M. 158 (2000). In an informal discussion with Robert P. Oliver, President of Management Planning, Inc., a well-recognized valuation firm, he indicated that the entity's ability to distribute income is considered in determining the size of minority and marketability discounts. Entities with high cash flow, such as income-producing real estate entities, will still warrant a significant discount, even if the agreement requires a certain amount of income to be distributed. Certainly, in the case of a marketable securities partnership, where the dividend yield may be less than 3%, a requirement to distribute (say) 45% of such income will have no impact on the valuation discounts. 2. The agreement should state that units can be sold to a third party, subject to a right of first refusal by the manager/general partner at "fair market value", and that gift transfers to related parties are permitted without consent. The right of first refusal is very common in family entity agreements and, according to Mr. Oliver, will have no impact on the valuation discount. 3. For an entity with non-income-producing property (such as vacant land or a young tree farm), or where the requirement of a stated distribution may have an impact on the discount, to further buttress the taxpayer's argument for the existence of a present interest, clients should also be advised to consider a "put" right, whereby the members/limited partners can sell their units to the entity for a limited period after receipt (say, 60 days) at the "fair market value." The agreement can provide that "fair market value" should be determined as if the "put" right did not exist (i.e., at a discounted value, assuming that there is little marketability for the units). The put right is similar to a Crummey power used in trusts to achieve a present interest. The put right should dispel any IRS argument that a right of first refusal is illusory if a market is lacking. According to Mr. Oliver, the use of a fair market value standard should preserve the discount, because it is a price to be negotiated. According to Mr. Oliver, a put right, as described above, has no impact on valuation discounts. However, if a stated price is defined in a way that deviates from a fair market value standard, normal valuation discounts may not apply. CONCLUSION. The Hackl case will be appealed, according to the taxpayers' attorneys. There are grounds to believe that favorable arguments exist to overturn the Tax Court decision. For example, the court did not analyze the significance of the right of a donee, without the consent of the manager, to sell his membership units to a "mere assignee," who would have limited rights in the LLC. The mere assignee would not rise to the level of a member. However, the membership units transferred to the assignee would possess immediate economic benefits. Furthermore, the court ignored the fact that the agreement in Hackl did impose a good faith standard on the managing member with regard to his duties, which would include the distribution of income. Even though no income was anticipated for a number of years, the fact that a good faith standard existed may be sufficiently persuasive to the appellate court to overturn the Tax Court decision. The Tax Court decision implicitly confirms that the provisions of the LLC in Hackl, most of which are fairly conventional and consistent with provisions seen in commercial transactions, do significantly reduce the value of LLC membership interests. Nevertheless, until the appeal is decided, when the use of the annual exclusion is important in the planning, practitioners will consider drafting agreements to avoid the result in Hackl. A dialogue with the appraiser will be important, to confirm that a right to income distributions, a put right and a right of first refusal will not materially reduce the normal valuation discounts that are available. 28 ACTEC Journal 87 (2002) Adversity After Bosch by Shirley L. Kovar* San Diego, California I. FRAMING THE ISSUE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89 A. There Is No Federal Property Law . . . . . . .89 B. The Goal: Settle Controversies Without Adverse Tax Consequences . . . . . . . . . . . .89 1. Property Rights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .89 2. Favorable Tax Results . . . . . . . . . . . . .89 II. BEFORE BOSCH: WHERE’S THE COLLUSION? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 A. Complete Deference to State Court Judgment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 B. Non-collusive Standard for State Court Judgments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 1. Freuler v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 2. Blair v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 3. Conflict Among the Circuits . . . . . . . .90 III. ESTATE OF BOSCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 A. The Issue in Bosch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 B. Narrow Holding: No Binding Deference to State Trial Court Order . . . . . . . . . . . . .90 C. Bosch Involved Two Federal Estate Tax Controversies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 1. Validity of Release of General Power of Appointment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 2. Negation of State Proration of Taxes Statute . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 3. Three Positions Over Past Thirty Years .91 4. Supreme Court: “We look at the problem differently.” . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 5. Proper Regard Serves Three Objectives. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .91 D. There Were Extensive Dissenting Opinions. 92 1. Dissent by Justice Douglas . . . . . . . . .92 a. Precedent for Comity to Lower State Court Decisions . . . . . . . . . .92 b. Invalid Premise of Tax-Driven Judgments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92 c. Unfairness to Taxpayer . . . . . . . . .92 2. Justice Harlan Dissented, Joined by Justice Fortas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92 a. Genuinely Adversary Proceeding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92 b. Justice Douglas’ Approach Unfair to Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92 c. Majority Approach Is Unworkable .92 * Copyright 2002. Shirley L. Kovar. All rights reserved. 28 ACTEC Journal 88 (2002) 3. Justice Fortas Wrote His Own Separate Dissent. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92 IV. THE PRACTICAL IMPACT OF BOSCH . .92 A. The IRS Will Rarely Be a Party in the Lower Court Proceeding. . . . . . . . . . . .92 1. Service Cannot Be Forced to Participate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92 2. Policy of Service Not to Participate . .92 B. Federal Court Practice: “Proper Regard” Is “No Regard” . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .92 1. “No regard” . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93 2. De Novo Review . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93 3. Law or Fact . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93 C. Catch-22 for the IRS? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93 1. Highest State Courts Approve Tax-Driven Cases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93 2. Highest Court of State Granted Reformation to Reduce Taxes . . . . . . .93 3. Highest Court of State Dismisses Case. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93 D. Service Sees Gloss on Bosch: State’s Highest Court Decision Not Always Binding: G.C.M. 39183 (1984) . . . . . . . . .93 E. “Having Your Cake…”: Service Says State Court Decision Bars Relitigation. . . .93 V. THE SCOPE OF BOSCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93 A. Settlement Agreements: Good Faith and Good Law . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .93 1. Pre-Bosch: Standard of Good Faith . . .93 2. Ahmanson: Bosch Requires Good Law, Not Just Good Faith . . . . . . . . . .93 3. Enforceable Right Is Essential . . . . . . .94 B. Does Bosch Apply Only to Federal Estate Tax Cases? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94 VI. ADVERSITY AFTER BOSCH . . . . . . . . . . .94 A. Justice Harlan Dissent in Bosch . . . . . . . .94 B. Despite Bosch, Many Federal Courts Focus on Adversity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94 1. After Bosch, Four Circuits, and Certain Other Courts Focus on Adversity . . . .94 2. The First Circuit: Estate of Abely v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94 3. The Second Circuit: Lemle v. United States of America . . . .94 4. The Fifth Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .94 a. Bath v. United States of America .94 b. Brown v. United States of America .94 c. Estate of Warren v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue . . . . . . . . . . . .95 d. Robinson v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue . . . . . . . . . . . . .96 e. Estate of Delaune v. United States .96 5. The Seventh Circuit: Estate of Greene v. United States of America . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96 6. Other courts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96 a. Burke v. United States . . . . . . . . . .96 b. Estate of Bennett v. Commissioner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .96 c. Estate of Simpson v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue . . . . . . . . . . . .96 C. More from the Service Regarding Adversity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97 1. The Argument of the Service in Bosch .97 2. Focus on Adversity: a Disclaimer Case: Estate of Goree v. Commissioner . . . . .97 a. Factual Background . . . . . . . . . . .97 b. The IRS in Tax Court . . . . . . . . . .97 c. The Tax Court decision . . . . . . . . .97 d. The AOD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97 D. The General Rule for Reformation/ Modification: The Completed Transaction Doctrine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .97 1. The “Completed Transaction” Rule . . .97 2. AFTER the Taxable Event . . . . . . . . . .97 3. BEFORE the Taxable Event at Issue . .98 4. WHEN is the Taxable Event? . . . . . . .98 5. PLR 200033015: Even the Service Approves This Retroactive Reformation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .98 VI. PRACTICE THOUGHTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99 A. Potential Disadvantages of Disclaimers . . .99 1. Friendly Family Situation . . . . . . . . . .99 2. Adversarial Situation . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99 B. Try to Avoid De Novo Review of Probate Court Order by the Service and/or Federal Court . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .99 C. Development of the Case in General . . . . .99 D. Preparation of Settlement Agreement . . . .99 E. Attorney-Prepared Orders . . . . . . . . . . . .100 1 ADVERSITY AFTER BOSCH “But under Bosch we may accord ‘proper regard’ to the decree, whatever that means.”1 I. FRAMING THE ISSUE A. There Is No Federal Property Law There is no federal property law. As a result, the federal transfer tax system looks to state law to determine whether property has been transferred in a manner that is subject to tax under the federal estate, gift, or generation-skipping transfer tax. Morgan v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue, 309 U.S. 78, 80 (1940). Although state law is determinative for federal transfer tax purposes, in many cases it is difficult to decide what the appropriate result is under state law even if a state court has actually ruled how state law should apply for local law purposes. The problem stems from the Supreme Court’s decision in Commissioner of Internal Revenue v. Estate of Bosch, 387 U.S. 456 (1967). In that case, the Supreme Court held that “Where the federal tax liability turns upon the character of a property interest held and transferred by the decedent under state law, federal authorities are not bound by the determination made of such property interest by a state trial court.” Id. at 457. B. The Goal: Settle Controversies Without Adverse Tax Consequences This outline discusses how the Bosch decision and its progeny affect the ability of taxpayers to settle controversies as to the meaning of wills and trusts and to correct mistakes in such documents without adverse tax consequences. Caution! The preferable path to desired property rights at the state court level may conflict with the complex maze required to achieve favorable federal tax results. 1. Property Rights: The preferable approach to resolving property rights is probate court approval of your client’s uncontested petition, or at worst, a petition followed by a settlement agreement among the interested parties and a consent decree from the probate court. 2. Favorable Tax Results: Favorable tax results may require proof of an adversarial proceeding, despite the rejection of adversity as an appropriate test in Estate of Bosch, supra. Lake Shore Nat’l Bank v. Coyle, 296 F. Supp. 412, 418 (N.D. Ill. 1968), rev’d on other grounds, 419 F. 2d 958 (7th Cir. 1969). 28 ACTEC Journal 89 (2002) II. BEFORE BOSCH: WHERE’S THE COLLUSION? A. Complete Deference to State Court Judgment 1. The Supreme Court in 1916 in Uterhart v. United States, 240 U.S. 598 (1916) gave complete deference to a state trial court decree in later federal tax litigation regarding the “succession taxes” paid by appellants under the act of June 13, 1898. 2. “[O]ne of the executors brought suit in the Supreme Court of the State of New York [the state trial court] against his co-executors and the beneficiaries for a judicial construction of the will, and a decree was made on the date mentioned….” Id. at 602. “It is very properly admitted by the Government that the New York decree is in this proceeding binding with respect to the meaning and effect of the will.” Id. at 603. B. Non-Collusive Standard for State Court Judgments 1. In the 1930s, the Court applied a “non-collusive” test in two income tax cases, Freuler v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue, 291 U.S. 35 (1934) and Blair v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue, 300 U.S. 5 (1937). a. In Freuler, the trustee filed fiduciary income tax returns, which deducted from gross income an amount for depreciation, but the trustee did not deduct the depreciation amount from income distributed to the beneficiaries. The Commissioner determined a deficiency on a beneficiary’s return. The beneficiary appealed to the Board of Tax Appeals. b. While the case was pending before the Board, the trustee obtained an order from a California lower court, which found the trustee had overpaid income to the beneficiaries and ordered the beneficiaries to repay the overpayment to the trust. The Board of Tax Appeals reversed the Commissioner, holding the state court’s judgment conclusive that the Trustee had overpaid the income to the beneficiaries. c. The Circuit Court of Appeals reversed the Board, upholding the Commissioner’s ruling. The Supreme Court granted certiorari and reversed the Circuit Court of Appeals. d. The Supreme Court accepted the lower court’s judgment a statement of the law of the state: “Moreover, the decision of that court, until reversed or overruled, establishes the law of California respecting distribution of the trust estate. It is nonetheless a declaration of the law of the State because not based on a statute, or earlier decisions. The rights of the beneficiaries are property rights and the court has adjudicated them. What the law as announced by that court adjudges distributable is, we think, to be so considered… .” Id. at 641, 642. e. The Supreme Court also rejected the 28 ACTEC Journal 90 (2002) Commissioner’s argument that the state court proceeding was “a collusive one—collusive in the sense that all the parties joined in a submission of the issues and sought a decision which would adversely affect the Government’s right to additional income tax.” Id. at 642. f. The Court described the “usual” procedure of the lower court leading up to the lower court’s order, apparently equating “collusive” with a non-adversarial proceeding. The Court concluded “[t]he decree purports to decide issues regularly submitted and not to be in any sense a consent decree.” In apparent support of this conclusion the Court noted that “[t]he court ruled against the remaindermen on one point and in their favor on another…but refused to surcharge the trustee, for reasons stated … .” Id. 2. In Blair, the Supreme Court determined that whether assignments of income from a trust were valid depended on whether the trust was or was not a spendthrift trust under local law. a. The Court upheld the order of the “intermediate appellate court” that the trust was not a spendthrift trust and the assignments were valid. b. The Supreme Court rejected the allegation that the decree was “collusive.” The Court gave no definition of “collusive” or any set of criteria for assessing whether the decree was “collusive.” The Court simply recited that “[t]he trustees were entitled to seek the instructions of the court having jurisdiction of the trust” and that the appellate court had “reviewed the decisions of the Supreme Court of the State and reached a deliberate conclusion.” Id. at 469, 470. 3. Conflict Among the Circuits a. The courts spent the next thirty years attempting to frame a workable definition of “collusion.” Some courts used collusion to mean “fraud.” Other courts equated collusive with “non-adversary.” The result was a confusing history of the application of the collusive standard in the pre-Bosch era. Caron, The Federal Tax Implications of Bush v. Gore, Univ. of Cincinnati Public Law Research Paper No. 01-1, Working Papers (http://www.uc.edu.law.edu.) at 7, 8. b. The Supreme Court noted the “widespread conflict among the circuits” and granted certiorari in Estate of Bosch, supra. III. ESTATE OF BOSCH A. The Issue in Bosch “Whether a federal court or agency in a federal estate tax controversy is conclusively bound by a state trial court adjudication of property rights or characterization of property interests when the United States is not made a party to such a proceeding.” Id. at 456, 457. B. Narrow Holding: No Binding Deference to State Trial Court Order “We hold that where the federal estate tax liability turns upon the character of a property interest held and transferred by the decedent under state law, federal authorities are not bound by the determination made of such property interest by a state trial court.” Id. at 457. C. Bosch Involved Two Federal Estate Tax Controversies 1. Validity of Release of General Power of Appointment a. In one case, the decedent had created a revocable trust that provided the decedent’s wife with income for her lifetime and a general power of appointment. The wife subsequently signed a document purporting to release the general power and convert it to a special power. b. The ensuing controversy was whether or not the release was valid. If the release was valid, there would be no marital deduction. c. The state court determined the release was invalid. The Tax Court accepted the state court judgment. The Court of Appeals affirmed. The Supreme Court reversed and remanded. 2. Negation of State Proration of Taxes Statute a. State Court Allowed Marital Deduction In the second case, the decedent’s will provided that ‘the provisions of any statute requiring the apportionment or proration of such [death] taxes among the beneficiaries of this will…shall be without effect in the settlement of my estate.’ The state court determined that this language was not sufficient to negate proration and allocated the entire federal estate tax against the non-marital trust. Id. at 460. This determination “allowed the widow a marital deduction of some $3,600,000 clear of all federal estate tax.” Id. at 461. b. State Court Ruling Is Not Binding The Commissioner determined the Probate Court ruling was in error, not binding on him, and assessed a deficiency. The District Court and Appellate Courts both agreed that the State Court ruling was not binding. 3. Three Positions Over Past Thirty Years The Court gave a brief history of “what effect must be given a state trial court decree where the matter decided there is determinative of federal estate tax consequences ….” Id. at 462, quoting Gallagher v. Smith, 223 F.2d 218, 225. a. The Court observed that three positions had evolved over the past thirty years: The first position was that ‘if the question at issue is fairly pre- sented to the state court for its independent decision and is so decided by the court the resulting judgment if binding upon the parties under the state law is conclusive as to their property rights in the federal tax case….’ Id. at 463. b. The second “opposite view” is similar to the approach of Erie Railroad Co. v. Tompkins, 304 U.S. 64 (1938) “in that the federal court will consider itself bound by the state court decree only after independent examination of the state law as determined by the highest court of the State.” Id. c. The Government urged a third “intermediate position”: a state trial court decree should be binding “only when the judgment is the result of an adversary proceeding in the state court.” Id. 4. Supreme Court: “We look at the problem differently.” a. Applying Federal Tax Statute: Legislative History i. The Court pointed out that it was being asked to apply a federal taxing statute. As a result, the Court explained it was necessary to review the legislative history of that statute. Id. at 463. ii. Accordingly the Court noted that the report of the Senate Finance Committee that recommended enactment of the marital deduction stated that “proper regard” and not “finality” should be given to state court judgments. Id. at 464. iii. Congress intended the marital deduction to be “strictly construed and applied.” b. Deference Owed to Highest Court of the State The Court relied on Erie v. Tompkins in rendering its opinion that “the underlying substantive rule involved is based on state law and the State’s highest court is the best authority on its own law.” Id. at 465. c. ‘Proper Regard’ is Standard for Trial Court Judgments If there is no decision by the state’s highest court, “then federal authorities must apply what they find to be the state law after giving ‘proper regard’ to relevant rulings of other courts of the State. In this respect, it may be said to be, in effect, sitting as a state court.” Id. 5. Proper Regard Serves Three Objectives The Court said in conclusion that the standard of “proper regard” would carry out three objectives (Id. at 465): a. That “proper regard” would “avoid much of the uncertainty that would result from the ‘non-adversary’ approach”; b. That “proper regard” would be “fair to the taxpayer”; and c. That “proper regard” would “protect the federal revenue as well.” 28 ACTEC Journal 91 (2002) D. There Were Extensive Dissenting Opinions 1. Dissent by Justice Douglas Douglas concluded that absent a consent decree, collusion or fraud, “the federal court should consider the [state court] decision to be an exposition of the controlling state law… . ” Id. at 471. a. Precedent for Comity to Lower State Court Decisions In diversity cases “we have never suggested that the federal court may ignore a relevant state court decision because it was not entered by the highest state court.” Id. at 466. To the contrary, Justice Douglas cited cases to the effect that “the federal court is obligated to follow the decision of a lower state court in the absence of decisions of the State Supreme Court showing that the state law is other than announced by the lower court.” Id. b. Invalid Premise of Tax-Driven Judgments Justice Douglas asserted that the lack of respect for state court decisions are based on the invalid premise “that such proceedings are brought solely to avoid federal taxes.” Justice Douglas explained that there are “many instances in which the parties desire a determination of their rights for other than tax reasons.” Id. at 470. c. Unfairness to Taxpayer Justice Douglas also pointed out that a federal court decision contrary to a state court decision would be unfair to the taxpayer if a federal court judgment imposes a tax on the taxpayer for a benefit that the taxpayer did not receive under state law. An example is explained in Blair v. Comm., supra, “where the Government attempted to tax the taxpayer for income to which he had no right under state law.” Id. 2. Justice Harlan dissented, Joined by Justice Fortas a. Genuinely adversary proceeding i. Harlan framed his holding as follows: “in cases in which state-adjudicated property rights are contended to have federal tax consequences, federal courts must attribute conclusiveness to the judgment of a state court, of whatever level in the state procedural system, unless the litigation from which the judgment resulted does not bear the indicia of a genuinely adversary proceeding.” Id. at 481. ii. Justice Harlan concluded that “the federal interest requires only that the Commissioner be permitted to obtain from the federal courts a considered adjudication of the relevant state law issues in cases in which…the state courts have not already provided such an adjudication.” Harlan said that a state court has made such a judgment if the state court “has had the benefit of reasoned argument from parties holding genuinely inconsistent interests.” [emphasis 28 ACTEC Journal 92 (2002) added.] Id. b. Justice Douglas’ Approach Unfair to Government Justice Douglas would, Justice Harlan says, “create excessive risks that federal taxation will be evaded through…judgments from lower state courts…not to resolve truly conflicting interests among the parties but rather as a predicate for gaining foreseeable tax advantages, and in which the point of view of the United States had never been presented or considered.” Id. at 480. c. Majority Approach Is Unworkable On the other hand, Justice Harlan believed the majority approach is unworkable: “. . . absent a judgment of the State’s highest court, federal courts must under this rule reexamine and, if they deem it appropriate, disregard the previous judgment of a state court on precisely the identical question of state law.” This, Harlan says, “ . . . might be widely destructive both of the proper relationship between state and federal law and of the uniformity of the administration of law within a state.” Id. 3. Justice Fortas wrote his own separate dissent. IV. THE PRACTICAL IMPACT OF BOSCH A. The IRS Will Rarely Be a Party in the Lower Court Proceeding. There is agreement that res judicata does not apply where the IRS is not a party in the lower court proceeding. See Estate of Bosch, supra, at 463; Douglas, (dissenting on other grounds), at 466. 1. Service Cannot Be Forced to Participate. As a practical matter, the IRS will rarely be a party in the lower court proceeding. “[E]fforts through the years subsequent to the Bosch decision to bring the government into such cases have been fruitless. The United States as sovereign, and the Service as an agency of the United States, are immune from suit in state court. This sovereign immunity may be waived only by Congress. In state property disputes that have federal tax consequences, the Service cannot be forced to participate.” Bruce, Bosch and Other Dilemmas: Binding the Parties and the Tax Consequences in Trust Dispute Resolution, Institute on Estate Planning, 9-1, 9-23 (1984). 2. Policy of Service Not to Participate If an attempt is made to make the Service a party to a lower state court proceeding, the policy of the Service is to refuse to participate. Typically, a government representative would make a special appearance for the purpose of obtaining a dismissal of the action. Id. B. Federal Court Practice: “Proper Regard” Is “No Regard” 1. “No regard” Sixty percent (60%) of federal courts from 1967-2001 “have refused to follow the state court’s interpretation of state law in the federal tax proceeding.” Caron, Federal Tax Implications, at 17, 18. 2. De Novo Review “At best, they give mere lip service to the Bosch ‘proper regard’ standard. In most cases, they engage in de novo review of state law without giving any weight to the state court decision.” Id. at 23, 24. 3. Law or Fact Very few decisions involved pure questions of law subject to de novo review. Most cases involved factual issues or mixed issues of fact and law. Id. at 45. C. Catch-22 for the IRS? 1. Highest State Courts Approve Tax-Driven Cases Bosch is usually interpreted to mean that federal authorities must give binding deference to the decisions of the highest court of the state and to state statutes. Where a decision of the highest court is for the purpose of giving effect to the parties’ agreement to achieve a specific result for tax purposes, Bosch actually helps bring about the kind of tax objectives that Bosch explicitly disapproves. See the discussion in Gans, “Federal Transfer Taxation and the Role of State Law: Does the Marital Deduction Strike the Proper Balance?” 48 Emory Law Journal 871 (Summer, 1999). 2. See e.g., Simches v. Simches, 671 N.E.2d 1226 (1996) (Highest court of the State granted decree for reformation that reduced taxes.) 3. But see, Kirchick v. Guerry, 706 N.E. 2d 702 (1999). The issue in Kirchick was what was the date the power of appointment was created. The court determined there was no state law duty or issue at stake. The court said the only reason for the suit was to obtain a ruling that could be used in a pending federal tax case. The court dismissed the suit. D. Service Sees Gloss on Bosch: State’s Highest Court Decision Not Always Binding: G.C.M. 39183 (1984) 1. “[T]he Estate Tax Attorney asserts that [the cited supreme court case] was a ‘carefully orchestrated, nonadversary lawsuit in state court designed only to obtain federal estate tax relief….’” Id. at 8. 2. “[T]he Bosch court did not intend for the federal courts and agencies to give binding effect to nonadversary state Supreme Court proceeding… .” Id. at 30. V. THE SCOPE OF BOSCH A. Settlement Agreements: Good Faith and Good Law 1. Pre-Bosch: Standard of Good Faith a. In pre-Bosch Revenue Ruling 66-139 (1966-1 C.B. 225) the Service determined that the amount given to a surviving spouse pursuant to a goodfaith settlement agreement qualified for the marital deduction. b. The Service relied on Lyeth v. Hoey, 305 U.S. 188 (1938), an income tax case, where the taxpayer argued that the amount he received in the settlement of a will contest should be excludible from income as an inheritance. c. The Court in Lyeth agreed with the taxpayer that the amount received by the taxpayer as a settlement was excludible from income as an inheritance. 2. Ahmanson: Bosch Requires Good Law, Not Just Good Faith. a. In Ahmanson Foundation v. United States, 674 F. 2d 761 (1981) the Ninth Circuit extended Bosch to settlement agreements. b. The court explained that the majority in Bosch concluded that “the test of ‘passing’ for estate tax purposes should be whether the interest reaches the spouse pursuant to state law, correctly interpreted-not whether it reached the spouse as a result of a good faith adversary confrontation.” Id. at 774. c. In Ahmanson, the surviving wife was entitled to the benefit of a marital trust valued at $5,000,000. Mrs. Ahmanson also received $750,000 from the estate in settlement of certain claims against the will. The government argued the estate was not entitled to a marital deduction for the settlement of the wife’s claim of the $750,000 payment. d. The court determined that it could not “square” Rev. Ruling 66-139 with Bosch: “Bosch would require that the interest be enforceable; the revenue ruling appears only to require that the state law claim be sufficiently plausible to support good faith arm’s length settlement. For this reason the revenue ruling, which predates Bosch, is of no effect.” Id. Spivey, “Completed Transactions, Qualified Reformation and Bosch: When Does the IRS Care about State Law of Trust Reformation?” ACTEC Notes, V. 26, No. 4, (Spring, 2001) 346, n.2, citing Levy v. U.S., 776 F. Supp. 831 (DNY 1991) (res judicata) and Baily v. U.S., 350 F. Supp. 1205 (D PA 1972) (collateral estoppel). 2 E. “Having Your Cake….”2 Service Says State Court Decision Bars Relitigation. But the Service may (in some states) assert res judicata “to bar a taxpayer from relitigating a property law issue decided adversely to the taxpayer in a state court proceeding.” 28 ACTEC Journal 93 (2002) 3. Enforceable Right Is Essential a. The Service relied on Bosch and Ahmanson in the Estate of Brandon, 828 F. 2d 493 (8th Cir.1987), persuading the Eighth Circuit that “under even the most narrow reading of Bosch, either a good faith settlement or a judgment of a lower state court must be based on an enforceable right, under state law properly interpreted, in order to qualify as ‘passing’ pursuant to the estate tax marital deduction.” Id. at 499, citing Ahmanson, supra, at 775. b Subsequent rulings of the Service conform to the Bosch-Ahmanson view that an essential, if not sufficient, component of a settlement agreement is a legally enforceable claim under state law. See e.g., Revenue Ruling 83-107 (“clarifying” Revenue Ruling 66-139 “to emphasize that only good faith negotiated settlements based on a surviving spouse’s enforceable rights to a deductible interest, under properly interpreted state law, will be recognized for purposes of section 2056….”[emphasis added]); PLR 200127038 (“In view of Ahmanson, property passing pursuant to the settlement of a claim asserted by a spouse will be treated as passing from the decedent, to the extent the compromise is a bona fide settlement of a legally enforceable claim.” [emphasis added] Id. at 20.); PLR 200004014 (“… the interests to be received by the parties (both as to the nature of the interests and their economic value) are consistent with the relative merit of the claims asserted by the parties.”[emphasis added] Id. at 16, 17.) B. Does Bosch Apply Only to Federal Estate Tax Cases (or Even Only to Marital Deduction Cases) and Not to Income Tax Cases? The argument could be made that Bosch should be limited to the marital deduction. Bosch resolved marital deduction issues, not other federal estate tax issues. Bosch focused on the legislative history of the marital deduction and borrowed the term “proper regard” from that legislative history. The Fifth Circuit has declined to apply Bosch in the context of the amount of the charitable deduction. Estate of Warren v. Commissioner, 981 F. 2d 776 (5th Cir. 1993). However, other courts and the Service have relied on Bosch beyond the marital deduction. See cases cited in Gans, supra, note 101, including, e.g., Dancy v. Commissioner, 872 F. 2d 84, 85 (4th Cir. 1989) (validity of disclaimer); United States v. White, 853 F. 2d 107 (2d Cir. 1988) (deductibility of administration expenses); PLR 9528012 (grandfathered generation-skipping trust);PLR 9308032 (taxable gift). Lyeth in Income Tax and Ahmanson in Transfer Tax In general, since Ahmanson, courts have applied Lyeth, supra, in the income tax context and 28 ACTEC Journal 94 (2002) Bosch where transfer taxes are at issue. This “bifurcated approach” has resulted in greater deference being shown to settlement agreements and lower court decisions involving income tax than cases deciding transfer tax issues, where the Bosch standard is applied. See Gans, supra, at 896 and 897. VI. ADVERSITY AFTER BOSCH A. Justice Harlan, Dissent in Bosch See discussion above at III. D. 2. B. Despite Bosch, Many Federal Courts Focus on Adversity 1. After Bosch, four circuits, and certain other courts, notwithstanding rejection of the adversity test in Bosch, have focused on the presence or absence of adversity in the lower state court proceeding. See cases cited in Caron, Federal Tax Implications, supra at 24, n.86. The following cases are examples of courts that have focused on adversity after Bosch. 2. The First Circuit: Estate of Abely v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue, 489 F. 2d 1327 (1st Cir. 1974) In Estate of Abely, the court affirmed the Tax Court judgment that the award of a family allowance to the surviving spouse was contingent and did not qualify for the marital deduction. According to the court, “[w]hatever the motives of the heirs in perhaps assenting to, and in any event not appealing from a probate decree conspicuously outside of the scope of the statutory provision, the taxing powers of the government are not to be avoided by private arrangements contrary to the will even though they receive the gloss of a probate court decree.” Id. at 1328. 3. The Second Circuit: Lemle v. United States of America, 579 F. 2d 185 (2nd Cir. 1978) The Second Circuit affirmed the District Court’s judgment rejecting plaintiff’s claim to recover income tax paid on distributions from her husband’s estate. The court observed that “[n]o such private agreement should foreclose the government from collection of its taxes. Courts ‘will not be bound by the parties’ self-serving characterization of the settled claim’.” [citations omitted.] Id. at 188. 4. The Fifth Circuit a. Bath v. United States of America, 480 F. 2d 289 (5th Cir.1973) i. In Bath, the issue was “whether a payment received by taxpayer from his mother’s estate was a tax-free bequest or taxable compensation for services performed during his mother’s life.” Id. at 290. ii. “Especially suspect are characterizations, such as we have here, not the result of bona fide adversary proceedings.” Id. at 289 citing the dissent of Justice Douglas in Bosch, supra, at 471. b. Brown v. United States of America, 890 F. 2d 1329 (5th Cir. 1989) i. In Brown, the issue was whether a probate estate was unduly prolonged, resulting in the payment of federal income tax by the estate, rather than the beneficiary. The Fifth Circuit affirmed the District Court’s decision granting of summary judgment to the government. The Fifth Circuit held that the government properly assessed income tax against the beneficiary rather than the executor. ii. The key issue was “what degree of deference the district court should have accorded [the] state judgment.” The executor, after receiving a notice of deficiency (as beneficiary) petitioned the probate court to “find that the Estates required ongoing management and administration.” Id. at 1341. The probate court “entered an order authorizing [the executor] to continue to manage the assets of the Estates as independent executor until such time as he determined ‘in his sole discretion’ that it would be in the best interest of the beneficiaries to terminate the Estates.” Id. iii. The Fifth Circuit concluded that “[t]he relevance of a state court’s judgment to the resolution of a federal tax question will vary, depending on the particular tax statute involved as well as the nature of the state proceeding that produced the judgment.” Id. at 1342. The Fifth Circuit determined that the tax statute involved was section 641 (a)(3) of the Internal Revenue Code and that “the issue of whether administration has been unduly prolonged for purposes of section 641 (a)(3) of the Code is ultimately one of federal, not state, law.” Id. Next, the Fifth Circuit concluded “the judgment had no practical consequences apart from this federal tax controversy….” Id. This was true for two reasons: (1) The Court first focused on the non-adversary nature of the state court proceeding; and (2) second, under Texas law, the executor did not need an order from the probate court to continue estate administration: “An independent executor…has authority to determine when to terminate the administration of an estate free of any court intervention; and therefore…the judgment had no practical consequences apart from this federal tax controversy….” Id. c. Estate of Warren v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue, 981 F. 2d 776 (5th Cir. 1993) i. In Warren, the issue was whether the IRS was bound by a probate court judgment approving a settlement, which allocated the larger portion of estate administration expenses against the residuary postmortem income rather than residuary corpus. The Tax Court upheld the deficiency asserted by the IRS, which determined that it was not bound by the probate court judgment. The Fifth Circuit reversed, holding that the Tax Court erred in failing to give effect to the state probate court judgment. ii. The decedent’s will left the major- ity of her estate in two residuary charitable lead trusts, which would terminate in favor of the decedent’s children and grandchildren. The will provided that “[a]ll of my just debts, funeral expense, administration and testamentary expenses, and all estate, inheritance, transfer, and succession taxes…shall be paid out of my residuary estate…without apportionment.” The “residuary estate” was to ‘consist of my entire testamentary estate after satisfaction of any gifts under Article IV hereof, and after payment of those debts, expenses, and taxes referred to in Article III hereof.’ Id. at 777. The charities brought suit in the probate court, alleging that the administration expenses should be paid from residuary postmortem income rather than residuary corpus. iii. The charities’ suit was one of sixteen suits brought against the estate during the probate. Parties to most of the suits, including the administrators, the charitable trust beneficiaries and most claimants against the estate entered into an “omnibus settlement,” which included a provision that the will “would be restated to allocate payment of all administrative expenses out of the residuary postmortem income, not out of the residuary corpus.” Id. at 778. An agreed final judgment was entered by the probate court, which modified and approved the settlement. The probate court order provided that 271 ⁄2 % of the administrative expenses would be charged against the residuary corpus and the balance against postmortem residuary income. iv. After a review of Bosch and other authorities, the Fifth Circuit adopted the test in Brown, supra, that ‘the relevance of a state court’s judgment to the resolution of a federal tax question will vary, depending on the particular tax statute involved as well as the nature of the state proceeding that produced the judgment.’ Id. at 781. The court pointed out that there was no legislative history for the estate tax charitable deduction comparable to that for the estate tax marital deduction. The court did note, however, that it had been frequently recognized that Congress had sought to “encourage gifts to charity” by its enactment of the charitable deduction in Internal Code section 2055 and prior statutes. Further, citing Flanagan, the court observed that in upholding charitable deductions based on court approved bona fide settlements of adversarial positions, the decisions have stressed that ‘the deduction is sought for the actual benefit passing to the charitable foundation.’ Id. at 782. v. The court emphasized that Texas law “has long recognized the ‘family settlement doctrine’” which is an “alternative method of administration in Texas that is a favorite of the law.” Id. Because Texas probate law vests the decedent’s estate immediately in the beneficiaries, they are “free to arrange among themselves for the distribution of the estate and 28 ACTEC Journal 95 (2002) for the payment of expenses from that estate.” [citation omitted]. Id. vi. The court rejected the Commissioner’s argument that the settlement as to the allocation of administrative expenses, “…was collusive and designed simply to avoid payment of taxes… .” Id. at 783. Instead, the Court concluded that “[it] is indisputably clear that the litigation, and its settlement, were to resolve adversarial, non-tax, bona fide disputes.” Id. at 783. d. Robinson v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue, 70 F.3d 34 (5th Cir. 1995) In Robinson, the Fifth Circuit reversed the portion of a lower court judgment that determined that certain settlement proceeds were excludable from gross income. The court explained that “[i]n the case at bar…the Tax Court found that the allocation was not entered in a bona fide adversary proceeding. Further, it found that the state trial court simply ‘rubber stamped’ a judgment drafted by the…attorneys.” Id. at 37. e. Estate of Delaune v. United States, 143 F. 3d 995 (5th Cir. 1998), cert. denied, 525 U.S. 1072 (1999) In Delaune, the Fifth Circuit, in reversing a district court decision, held that a disclaimer by a deceased heir’s heirs was valid under Louisiana law and was a valid disclaimer under Internal Revenue Code section 2518. However, based on Bosch, the Fifth Circuit relied on “this circuit’s longstanding interpretation of the rather ambivalent majority opinion in Bosch. Accordingly, if “the state court adjudication arises out of a manifestly non-adversarial proceeding and the relevant federal tax statute indicates no preference for the sanctity of the state court’s ruling, we need accord no particular deference, and must conduct our own investigation of the relevant state law as declared by the state’s highest court.” Id. at 1002. 5. The Seventh Circuit: Estate of Greene v. United States of America, 476 F. 2d 116 (7th Cir. 1973) In Greene, the Seventh Circuit affirmed the District Court’s order supporting the IRS determination that estate tax should be paid from property passing to the widow. “The district court may have also determined that the state court decision was not tempered by a ‘genuinely adversary proceeding’…for appellant did not contest the government’s representation on this appeal that no appearance was entered for the sons in the state probate court proceeding.” Id. at 119, 120. 6. Other Courts a. Burke v. United States, 994 F. 2d 1576 (Fed. Cir), cert denied, 510 U.S. 990 (1993) “In the case at bar, there was no bona 28 ACTEC Journal 96 (2002) fide adversarial proceeding leading to the Florida probate court’s decision to allow payment of administrative expenses out of post-mortem income. Therefore, even assuming that Bosch is limited to non-adversarial situations, it is applicable to this case…. Further, the decision in Warren would allow an agreement between the beneficiaries under a will to dictate federal estate tax law. While the settlement in Warren was undoubtedly the result of adversarial proceedings, it is hard to imagine that reducing federal estate tax consequences was not at least one aspect of the settlement agreement. Decreasing the amount of taxes owed would increase the overall post-tax amount of money which could be divided by both of the negotiating parties.” Id. at 1583, 1584. b. Estate of Bennett v. Commissioner, 100 T.C. 42 (1993) “While we do not suggest that the Trustees and the beneficiaries in the present case engaged in improper collusion with the Kansas probate court to obtain approval of the Rules and By-laws and the disclaimers, nonetheless that proceeding was nonadversarial and was instituted for the sole purpose of obtaining a marital deduction that was not otherwise available under the original terms of the will and Trust Agreement.” Id. at 60. c. Estate of Simpson v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue, 67 T.C.M. (CCH) 3062 (1994) “Taxpayers can achieve favorable but collusive results from State court proceedings in which the Commissioner has not been made a party or which appear to have been pursued for the purpose of affecting a Federal tax liability. Collusion does not imply fraudulent or improper conduct; rather, it implies that the parties have joined in submission of the issues such that there was no genuine issue of law or fact as to a beneficiary’s rights to or property interest in an estate.” [citations omitted] Id. at 17, 18. “The circuit court proceeding was neither a genuine and active contest nor adversarial in nature. We conclude that the circuit court did not pass upon the facts upon which the marital deduction depends. The settlement agreement was similarly not a good faith compromise of a bona fide dispute. Consequently, [her] receipt of her elective share in decedent’s estate was not a bona fide recognition of her right to it.” Id. at 20. C. More from the Service Regarding Adversity 1. The Argument of the Service in Bosch a. In its brief to the Supreme court in Bosch, the Service urged the Court to adopt the test of adversity in the state court proceeding as the way to balance the competing interests of revenue and comity. Petitioner’s Brief, Commissioner v. Estate of Bosch (No. 673) cited in Caron, Federal Tax Implications, supra, at 12. b. The Service urged that failure to give effect to a state court decision only in the case of fraud was too narrow a test, and that this approach would not give sufficient weight to the revenue interest of the government. Id. at 11. c On the other hand, the Service argued that if a federal court could impose a tax on a property right denied to the taxpayer under state law, that would be “too broad” and would give too much power to the federal courts. Id. at 12. d. The Service proposed that a federal court should review a state court judgment only when it was the result of a non-adversary state court proceeding. Id. 2. Focus on Adversity: A Disclaimer Case: Estate of Goree v. Commissioner, 68 T.C.M. (CCH) 123 (1994) a. Factual background i. According to the state law of intestacy, decedent’s estate would pass one-half to the decedent’s wife and one-half to their three children. The distribution to the children would generate significant estate tax liability. ii. The wife, as conservator for the children, requested the Court to approve a disclaimer by each of the three children, which would avoid the anticipated estate tax. Each child would accept $200,000 from the decedent’s estate, and disclaim any interest in the decedent’s estate above that amount. The result would be to use the decedent’s $600,000 unified credit for the distribution to the children and the disclaimer would cause the balance of the decedent’s estate to pass to the wife by intestacy, thereby deferring federal estate tax as a result of the marital deduction. iii. A guardian ad litem was appointed for the children. After a favorable recommendation by the guardian, the Court approved the disclaimers. b. The IRS in Tax Court i. In the Tax Court trial, the Service refused to recognize the validity of the disclaimers, arguing that the probate judge erred as a matter of state law in the decree approving the disclaimers. ii. The Service proposed, contrary to Bosch, that the Tax Court should give no weight to the decision of the probate court. The Service urged the Tax Court to engage in a de novo review and make an independent judgment whether the disclaimers were in the best interests of the children under state law. iii. The Service argued that it could not be in the best interest of the children to forego their intestate rights for no consideration. The Service therefore concluded that the wife’s request for approval of the disclaimers was solely to avoid adverse tax consequences. c. The Tax Court Decision i. The Tax Court used the same standard of review that the State supreme court would apply to a lower court decision. Therefore, the Tax Court would decide whether the state court decision was “plainly and palpably erroneous.” ii. The Tax Court determined that there were considerations in addition to reduction of taxes, including the desire to keep the stock of a closely-held corporation within the family and the probability that other elderly family members would leave large bequests to the children. iii. The Tax Court held that the probate court ruling that the disclaimers were in the best interests of the children was not “plainly and palpably erroneous” bequests to the children. d. The AOD i. The Service issued a non-acquiescence in the Estate of Goree, 1996-1 C.B.1, 1996-10 I.R.B.4 (I.R.S.). ii. The Service states that the Tax Court should have reviewed the state court judgment de novo, rather than applying an appellate standard of review. iii. “The utilization of the palpably erroneous standard for review of factual findings in a non-adversarial situation is inconsistent with the rationale for the palpably erroneous standard, which assumes a vigorously contested lower court hearing.” Id. at 3. D. The General Rule for Reformation/Modification: The Completed Transaction Doctrine 1. The “completed transaction” rule does not apply to “qualified reformations” pursuant to the Internal Revenue Code. 2. AFTER the Taxable Event at Issue (not including qualified reformations) 28 ACTEC Journal 97 (2002) In Rev. Rul. 93-79, 1993-2 C.B. 269, the Service determined that a state court order reforming a trust to meet the requirements of a qualified subchapter S Trust was not effective retroactively, although the Service would recognize the validity of the order for future years. The ruling cites, inter alia, American Nurseryman Publishing Company v. Commissioner, 75 T.C. 271, 276-277 (1980), aff’d without published opinion, 673 F. 2d 1333 (7th Cir. 1982); Estate of Hill v. Commissioner, 64 T.C. 867 (1975), aff’d without published opinion, 568 F. 2d 1365 (5th Cir. 1978). In PLR 199922045, the Service declined to give retroactive effect to a reformation of a trust by the probate court. Certain courts have made exceptions to the completed transaction rule. Flitcroft v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue, 328 F.2d 449 (9th Cir. 1964) (state court reformation changing revocable trusts was valid for federal estate tax purposes.) Another case not explained by the completed transaction rule is Estate of Kraus v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue, 875 F. 2d 597 (7th Cir. 1989) (retroactive reformation where scrivener’s error proved by clear and convincing evidence). 3. BEFORE the Taxable Event at Issue In Rev. Rul. 73-142, 1973-1 C.B. 405, the Service distinguished Bosch regarding the effect of state law as announced by the highest court of the state where the lower state court decree is contrary to the law as stated by the highest court of the state. In this ruling, “[t]he decedent made substantial gifts of property in trust for the benefit of his wife and children.” In the Trust instrument the decedent retained the “unrestricted power to remove or discharge the trustee at any time and appoint a new trustee, with no express limitation on so appointing himself.” The Trust also gave the Trustee an “unrestricted power to withhold distribution of income or principal and to apportion income and principal….” Id. at 1. Prior to his death the decedent, in 1965, petitioned and obtained an order in lower state court proceedings to construe the trust instrument as follows: (i) That the decedent “had reserved the right to remove and appoint a trustee only once….” (ii) “[T]hat this power did not include the right to appoint himself . . . .” (iii) “[T]hat once having exercised that power, decedent would have exhausted his reserved powers….” Id. at 1, 2. The Service determined that the lower court decree was effective for purposes of the federal estate tax, and that section 2036 and 2038 of the IRC did not require inclusion of the trust assets in the dece- 28 ACTEC Journal 98 (2002) dent’s gross estate for federal estate tax purposes. The Service explained that in Bosch the decree in question was rendered after the date of death of the decedent: “Unlike the situation in Bosch, the decree in this case was handed down before the time of the event giving rise to the tax (that is, the date of the grantor’s death). Thus, while the decree would not be binding on the Government as to questions relating to the grantor’s power to appoint himself as trustee prior to the date of the decree, it is controlling after such date since the decree, in and of itself, effectively extinguished the power. In other words, while there may have been a question whether the grantor had such power prior to the decree, there is no question that he did not have the power thereafter.” Id. at 5. For a recent ruling, see PLR 200127042 (analyzing a irrevocable life insurance trust reformed after the death of the husband but before death of the wife to avoid inclusion of trust proceeds in the estate of the wife.) 4. WHEN Is the Taxable Event? The government has argued that the appropriate measuring date is the date of the testator’s death. See e.g., Estate of Rapp v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue, 140 F. 3d 1211 (1998) and cases cited there by the court; Jackson v. United States, 376 U.S. 503, 505 (1964); Estate of Heim v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue, 914 F. 2d 1322, 1327 (9th Cir. 1990). With respect to the QTIP election, the court in the Estate of Rapp, supra, at 1218, noted that “three circuits have held that the correct ‘measuring date’ for determining whether a particular asset is considered part of a QTIP trust is the date of QTIP election, not the date of the testator’s death. See Estate of Spencer v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue, 43 F. 3d 226 (6th Cir. 1995); Estate of Robertson v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue, 15 F. 3d 779 (8th Cir. 1994); Estate of Clayton v. Commissioner of Internal Revenue, 976 F. 2d 1486 (5th Cir. 1992).” 5. PLR 200033015: Even the Service Approves This Retroactive Reformation In this Private Letter Ruling, the Service determined that a non-adversarial reformation by a state trial court did not have adverse income tax and gift tax consequences. The Service accepted the reformation as a correction of the irrevocable trust (Trust #1) to reflect trustor’s original intent and determined that the reformation would not generate any income tax or gift tax. The taxpayer had created two irrevocable trusts for the taxpayer’s five children (income beneficiaries) and grandchildren (remaindermen). Trust #1 recited that the word “child” and “grandchild” “shall not include descendants by adoption.” Id. at 5. One of the trustor’s children then adopted a child who would not qualify as a remainderman under Trust #1. The trustor claimed that she did not intend to exclude minor children as remaindermen, and that she only wanted to exclude any person who was an adult at the time of the adoption. The trustor’s attorney corroborated the trustor’s claims regarding the original intent of the trustor. Prior to the submission of the ruling request, the parties to Trust #1 agreed to the reformation. The agreement was followed by a petition to the court requesting reformation of Trust #1 that the terms “child” and “grandchild” would include “descendants by birth and any adopted person who lived while a minor (either before or after the adoption) as a regular member of the household of the adopting descendantby-birth.” Id. at 8. The ruling recited that Bosch determined that (1) “a decision of a state trial court as to an underlying issue of state law should not be controlling when applied to a federal statute…;” (2) “the highest court of the state is the best authority on the underlying…federal matter” and (3) “If there is no decision by that court then the federal authority must apply what it finds to be state law after giving ‘proper regard’ to the state trial court’s determination and to relevant rulings of other courts of the state.” Id. at 15 and 16. After citing lower court California cases regarding California law, the ruling concluded that “the reformation of Trust 1 is consistent with applicable California law as it would be applied by the highest court of California.” Id. at 17. The Service took the position that “the reformation based on a mistake in drafting does not change any of the beneficial interests in Trust 1, and, accordingly, the reformation will not give rise to gift tax liability for any party.” Id. The ruling concluded that the reformation did not arise “by reason of the Agreement.” Id. Rather, “the parties merely acknowledge Settlor’s original intent and state that they will not object to the reformation so long as they do not personally incur any gift tax or income tax liability….” Id. VI. PRACTICE THOUGHTS A. Potential Disadvantages of Disclaimers 1. Friendly Family Situation In a friendly family situation, if the court has approved a disclaimer by a minor child, the Service may claim there was no adversarial proceeding for approval of the disclaimers and therefore request a federal court to conduct a de novo review of the validity of the disclaimer under state law. In the proceedings regarding the disclaimer for a minor child, determine if there is any definition of the “best interests” of the minor child. In a proceeding relating to modification or termination, California Probate Code section 15405 provides that the court may consider the “general family benefit accruing to living members of the beneficiary’s family, as a basis for approving a modification or termination of the trust.” 2. Adversarial Situation a. In a more adversarial situation, it may be impossible to elicit a disclaimer from the adverse beneficiaries because the existence of consideration will invalidate the disclaimer for federal tax purposes. b. In adversarial situations the adverse party may require a guarantee of tax consequences, which, again is not possible because this would constitute consideration and invalidate the disclaimer. 3. Instead, if possible, prove there was a mistake in drafting. B. Try to Avoid De Novo Review of Probate Court Order by the Service and/or Federal Court. (The Service Will Want to See Signs of an Adversarial Proceeding) 1. Appoint a guardian ad litem for a minor child. The guardian should provide written, explicit recommendations. 2. Conduct a factual investigation. 3. The opposing party should file objections. C. Development of the Case in General 1. Rely on the strongest theory under state law that supports your client’s claim and also achieves favorable tax results. There may be multiple theories to support the client’s claim. 2. Unless the highest court of the state approves the probate court judgment or there is a state statute for tax minimization regarding the matter at issue, avoid tax reduction or tax deferral arguments. 3. Leave a paper trail of arm’s length negotiations or adversarial court proceedings. 4. Document the method used to calculate the value of your client’s claim. 5. Any settlement should reflect as closely as possible the actual economic value of the parties’ respective claims. 6. Leave searches for sympathy to the telephone or court chambers. D. Preparation of Settlement Agreement 1. Make extensive recitals of fact; avoid tax avoidance or tax deferral recitals. 2. Emphasize the factual basis of the claims. 28 ACTEC Journal 99 (2002) 3. Rely on and cite decisions of the highest court of the state or state statutes. 4. Depending upon the relationship of the parties, it may not be possible to avoid allocation of the risk of tax consequences. E. Attorney-Prepared Orders 1. Include extensive, detailed findings of fact that track the factual requirements under decisions of 28 ACTEC Journal 100 (2002) the highest court of the state or state statutes. 2. Emphasize the factual basis of the claims. 3. Ask the court to issue a ruling that includes findings of fact and conclusions of law. 4. Track the court ruling carefully in the attorney-prepared order. 5. Be sure the order provides it is retroactive to operative date (date of death, if possible). Punctilio of an Honor—A Trustee’s Duties by Robert J. Rosepink* Scottsdale, Arizona TABLE OF CONTENTS I. INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102 II. HOW A TRUSTEE’S DUTIES ARISE . . .102 A. Under the Trust Instrument . . . . . . . . . . . .102 B. Under Federal Law or Administrative Agency Regulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102 C. Under State Statute . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102 D. At Common Law . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102 E. Other Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .102 III. DUTIES OF A TRUSTEE UNDER THE UTC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 A. Duty to Administer Trust . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 B. Duty of Loyalty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .103 C. Impartiality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 D. Prudent Administration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 E. Costs of Administration . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 F. Trustee’s Skills . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 G. Delegation by Trustee . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 H. Powers to Direct . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .104 I. Control and Protection of Trust Property. .105 J. Record Keeping and Identification of Trust Property . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .105 K. Enforcement and Defense of Claims . . . .105 L. Collecting Trust Property . . . . . . . . . . . . .105 M. Duty to Inform and Report . . . . . . . . . . . .105 IV. DUTIES OF A TRUSTEE UNDER THE RESTATEMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106 A. Duty to Administer the Trust . . . . . . . . . .106 B. Duty of Loyalty . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .106 C. Duty with Respect to Delegation . . . . . . .106 D. Duty to Keep and Render Accounts . . . . .107 E. Duty to Furnish Information . . . . . . . . . . .108 F. Duty to Exercise Reasonable Care and Skill . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .108 G. Duty to Take and Keep Control . . . . . . . .108 H. Duty to Preserve the Trust Property . . . . .109 I. Duty to Enforce Claims . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109 J. Duty to Defend Actions . . . . . . . . . . . . . .109 K. Duty to Keep Trust Property Separate . . .109 L. Duty with Respect to Bank Deposits . . . .110 M. Duty to Make the Trust Property Productive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .110 N. Duty to Pay Income to Beneficiary . . . . .111 * Copyright 2002. Robert J. Rosepink. All rights reserved. O. Duty to Deal Impartially with Beneficiaries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111 P. Duty with Respect to Co-Trustees . . . . . .111 Q. Duty with Respect to Person Holding Power of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .111 V. EXCULPATORY PROVISIONS . . . . . . . .112 A. In General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112 B. UTC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .112 C. Restatement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113 VI. FIDUCIARY BONDS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113 A. In General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113 B. UTC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113 C. Restatement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113 VII. TYPES OF LIABILITY . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113 A. Personal Liability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113 B. Liability in a Representative Capacity . . .113 VIII. TRUSTEE’S RIGHT TO INDEMNITY FROM THE TRUST ESTATE . . . . . . . . .113 A. General Rules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .113 B. Indemnity for Contractual Liability . . . . .114 C. Indemnity for Tort Liability . . . . . . . . . . .115 D. Indemnity for Liability as a Title Holder of Property . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115 E. Indemnity Where Trust Estate Is Insufficient . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .115 IX. LIABILITY OF THE TRUSTEE TO THIRD PERSONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116 A. Personal Liability to Third Persons . . . .116 B. Contract Liability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116 C. Tort Liability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116 D. Property Liability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .116 X. LIABILITY OF THE TRUSTEE TO BENEFICIARIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118 A. Breach of Trust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118 B. Nonliability for Loss in the Absence of a Breach of Trust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118 C. Trustee’s Liability in Case of Breach of Trust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118 XI. SPECIAL AREAS OF CONCERN . . . . . .118 A. Successor Trustee . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .118 B. Breach of Trust by Co-Trustee . . . . . . . . .119 C. Acts of Agents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .119 D. Payments or Conveyances Made to Persons other than the beneficiary. . . . . . . . . . . . .119 28 ACTEC Journal 101 (2002) I. INTRODUCTION A. “Many forms of conduct permissible in a workaday world for those acting at arm’s length, are forbidden to those bound by fiduciary ties. A trustee is held to something stricter than the morals of the marketplace. Not honesty alone, but the punctilio of an honor most sensitive, is then the standard of behavior. As to this there has developed a tradition that is unbending and inveterate. Uncompromising rigidity has been the attitude of courts of equity when petitioned to undermine the rule of undivided loyalty by the ‘disintegrating erosion’ of particular exceptions. Only thus has the level of conduct for fiduciaries been kept at a level higher than that trodden by the crowd.” Meinhard v. Salmon, 249 NY 458, 164 NE 545, 564 (1928). B. “For as a trust is an office necessary in the concerns between man and man, and which, if faithfully discharged, is attended with no small degree of trouble, and anxiety, it is an act of great kindness to accept it.” Lord Chancellor Hardwicke in Knight v. Earl of Plymouth, 21 Eng Rep 214, 216 (1747). C. The title of this outline is intended to remind the reader at the outset that the standard of conduct to which a trustee is held under the law is significantly higher than anywhere else in the marketplace. Yet our clients routinely consider appointing as trustee of trusts with complicated dispositive or tax provisions one or more family members or acquaintances whose background, education, experience, and perspicacity rarely qualify them to understand, let alone properly execute the duties of the trustee. D. Although the powers of a trustee are often set forth in the trust instrument, the trustee’s duties usually are not. E. In addition, this outline discusses a trustee’s liability for breaches of trust–failure to perform the required duties according to the accepted standard of conduct. F. Although executors, administrators, and personal representatives (collectively, “PRs”) are clearly fiduciaries, probate is entirely a statutory process. The laws governing probate, including those determining the duties and liabilities of PRs, vary greatly from state to state. Although some of the duties and potential liability to which PRs are subject may be similar to those of a trustee, this outline does not discuss a PR’s duties. II. HOW A TRUSTEE’S DUTIES ARISE A. Under the trust instrument. B. Under federal law or administrative agency regulation. 1. Federal law imposes various direct and indirect duties on trustees. The best-known duties of a trustee under federal law are to pay various taxes. However, ERISA also imposes reporting requirements and increases trustee liability. 28 ACTEC Journal 102 (2002) 2. Treasury regulations impose numerous duties in connection with a trustee’s duties to pay income and transfer taxes. 3. The Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (“OCC”) imposes various duties on trustees subject to its jurisdiction–viz., national banks. See 12 CFR Parts 9 and 19. [A full discussion of Regulation 9 is beyond the scope of this outline.] C. Under state statute. 1. The nature and extent of statutes concerning a trustee’s duties vary widely from state to state. Some states have an extensive statutory scheme dealing with a trustee’s duties, while other states have almost no law on the subject. However, the Uniform Trust Code [hereinafter cited as “UTC”], which was adopted by the National Conference of Commissioners on Uniform State Laws in August 2000, “is the first effort by the Uniform Law Commissioners to provide the states with a comprehensive model for codifying the law of trusts.” English, David M., “The Uniform Trust Code (2000),” ACTEC 2000 Summer Meeting at 1. 2. As it enacted in more jurisdictions, the UTC will begin to create more uniformity from state to state. Although the UTC stands as the most up-to-date and thorough analysis of a trustee’s duties, there are as yet no cases analyzing its provisions. However, as Professor English, Reporter for the UTC points out: “The Uniform Trust Code was drafted in close coordination with the revision of the Restatement [(Second) of Trusts]. This coordination has hopefully made both into better products. The UTC offers the benefit of certain rules. The Restatement provides a wealth of background materials for interpreting the language of the UTC.” Id at 7. D. At common law. Where the duties of a trustee are not set forth in the trust instrument, trustees are subject to whatever duties are imposed on them by statute or which have “evolved by courts of equity for the governing of the conduct of trustees.” Scott, A.W. & W.F. Fratcher, The Law of Trusts § 164 (4th ed 1987) [hereinafter cited as “Scott”]. The Restatement of the Law (Second) Trusts, adopted and promulgated by the American Law Institute in 1959 [hereinafter cited as “Restatement”] describes seventeen separate duties imposed upon a trustee by common law (see IV. infra). The text and comment of several of the sections describing those duties (viz., sections 170, 171, 181, 183, and 184) were revised as part of the Restatement of the Law (Third) Trusts (Prudent Investor Rule) adopted and promulgated by the American Law Institute in 1990 [hereinafter cited as “Restatement 3d”]. E. Other sources. ACTEC Fellows should be familiar with the “Guide for ACTEC Fellows Serving as Trustees” which represents a “consensus of suggestions and considerations” dealing with trusteeships. III. DUTIES OF A TRUSTEE UNDER THE UTC A. Duty to administer trust. UTC § 801. [UTC text is quoted in bold.] 1. Upon acceptance of a trusteeship, the trustee shall administer the trust in good faith, in accordance with its terms and purposes and the interests of the beneficiaries, and in accordance with this [Code]. 2. This section is very similar to Restatement § 169. B. Duty of loyalty. UTC § 802. 1. (a) A trustee shall administer the trust solely in the interest of the beneficiaries. (b) Subject to the rights of persons dealing with or assisting the trustee as provided in Section 1012 [Protection of Person Dealing With Trustee], a sale, encumbrance, or other transaction involving the investment or management of trust property entered into by the trustee for the trustee’s own personal account or which is otherwise affected by a conflict between the trustee’s fiduciary and personal interests is voidable by a beneficiary affected by the transaction unless: (1) the transaction was authorized by the terms of the trust; (2) the transaction was approved by the court; (3) the beneficiary did not commence a judicial proceeding within the time allowed by Section 1005 [Limitation of Action Against Trustee]; (4) the beneficiary consented to the trustee’s conduct, ratified the transaction, or released the trustee in compliance with Section 1009 [Beneficiary’s Consent, Release, or Ratification]; or (5) the transaction involves a contract entered into or claim acquired by the trustee before the person became or contemplated becoming trustee. (c) A sale, encumbrance, or other transaction involving the investment or management of trust property is presumed to be affected with a conflict between personal and fiduciary interests if it is entered into by the trustee with: (1) the trustee’s spouse; (2) the trustee’s dependents, siblings, parents, or their spouses; (3) an agent or attorney of the trustee; or (4) a corporation or other person or enterprise in which the trustee, or a person that owns a significant interest in the trustee, has an interest that might affect the trustee’s best judgment. (d) A transaction between a trustee and a beneficiary that does not concern trust property but that occurs during the existence of the trust or while the trustee retains significant influence over the beneficiary and from which the trustee obtains an advantage is voidable by the beneficiary unless the trustee establishes that the transaction was fair to the beneficiary. (e) A transaction not concerning trust property in which the trustee engages in the trustee’s individual capacity involves a conflict between personal and fiduciary interests if the transaction concerns an opportunity properly belonging to the trust. (f) An investment by a trustee in securities of an investment company or investment trust to which the trustee, or its affiliate, provides services in a capacity other than as trustee is not presumed to be affected by a conflict between personal and fiduciary interests if the investment complies with the prudent investor rule of [Article] 9. The trustee may be compensated by the investment company or investment trust for providing those services out of fees charged to the trustee if the trustee at least annually notifies the person entitled under Section 813 [Duty to Inform and Report] to receive a copy of the trustee’s annual report of the rate and method by which the compensation was determined. (g) In voting shares of stock or in exercising powers of control over similar interests in other forms of enterprise, the trustee shall act in the best interests of the beneficiaries. If the trust is the sole owner of a corporation or other form of enterprise, the trustee shall elect or appoint directors or managers who will manage the corporation or enterprise in the best interests of the beneficiaries. (h) This section does not preclude the following transactions, if fair to the beneficiaries: (1) an agreement between a trustee and a beneficiary relating to the appointment or compensation of the trustee; (2) payment of reasonable compensation to the trustee; (3) a transaction between a trust and another trust, decedent’s estate, or [conservatorship] of which the trustee is a fiduciary or in which a beneficiary has an interest; (4) a deposit of trust money in a regulated financial-service institution operated by the trustee; or (5) an advance by the trustee of money for the protection of the trust. (i) The court may appoint a special fiduciary to make a decision with respect to any proposed transaction that might violate this section if entered into by the trustee. 28 ACTEC Journal 103 (2002) 2. This section is far more extensive than Restatement 3d § 170, which also imposes the duty of loyalty on a trustee. In general, this section of the UTC codifies the Restatement 3d Comments, with one important exception. Under UTC section 802, a corporate trustee may invest trust funds in a regulated mutual fund which it operates if doing so is “fair to the beneficiaries.” C. Impartiality. UTC § 803. 1. If a trust has two or more beneficiaries, the trustee shall act impartially in investing, managing, and distributing the trust property, giving due regard to the beneficiaries’ respective interests. 2. Presumably, just as with Restatement 3d section 183, this duty will apply whether the beneficiaries’ interests are simultaneous or successive. 3. “Due regard” will continue to pose a challenge for the trustee in selecting trust investments. An income beneficiary will favor investment in assets that tend to maximize current income, and a remainder beneficiary will favor investment in assets that tend to maximize the value of the trust principal over time, even if such assets produce less current income. D. Prudent Administration. UTC § 804. 1. A trustee shall administer the trust as a prudent person would, by considering the purposes, terms, distributional requirements, and other circumstances of the trust. In satisfying this standard, the trustee shall exercise reasonable care, skill, and caution. 2. This section, while similar to Restatement section 174, does not relate the hypothetical prudent person to dealing with his own property (or, as under Uniform Probate Code (hereinafter “UPC”) section 7302, the property of another). E. Costs of Administration. UTC § 805. 1. In administering a trust, the trustee may incur only costs that are reasonable in relation to the trust property, the purposes of the trust, and the skills of the trustee. 2. Although this section is included with others imposing duties on the trustee, it really expresses a power of the trustee. It is similar to Restatement section 188, Power to Incur Expenses. F. Trustee’s Skills. UTC § 806. 1. A trustee who has special skills or expertise, or is named trustee in reliance upon the trustee’s representation that the trustee has special skills or expertise, shall use those special skills or expertise. 2. This duty is expressed as part of Restatement section 174. G. Delegation by Trustee. UTC § 807. 1. (a) A trustee may delegate duties and powers that a prudent trustee of comparable skills 28 ACTEC Journal 104 (2002) could properly delegate under the circumstances. The trustee shall exercise reasonable care, skill, and caution in: (1) selecting an agent; (2) establishing the scope and terms of the delegation, consistent with the purposes and terms of the trust; and (3) periodically reviewing the agent’s actions in order to monitor the agent’s performance and compliance with the terms of the delegation. (b) In performing a delegated function, an agent owes a duty to the trust to exercise reasonable care to comply with the terms of the delegation. (c) A trustee who complies with subsection (a) is not liable to the beneficiaries or to the trust for an action of the agent to whom the function was delegated. (d) By accepting a delegation of powers or duties from the trustee of a trust that is subject to the law of this State, an agent submits to the jurisdiction of the courts of this State. 2. This section is consistent with the approach to delegation adopted by Restatement 3d section 171. 3. Exculpation of the trustee for actions of agents under subsection (c) is similar to Restatement section 225 (see IX.C. infra). H. Powers to Direct. UTC § 808. 1. (a) While a trust is revocable, the trustee may follow a direction of the settlor that is contrary to the terms of the trust. (b) If the terms of a trust confer upon a person other than the settlor of a revocable trust power to direct certain actions of the trustee, the trustee shall act in accordance with an exercise of the power unless the attempted exercise is manifestly contrary to the terms of the trust or the trustee knows the attempted exercise would constitute a serious breach of a fiduciary duty that the person holding the power owes to the beneficiaries of the trust. (c) The terms of a trust may confer upon a trustee or other person a power to direct the modification or termination of the trust. (d) A person, other than a beneficiary, who holds a power to direct is presumptively a fiduciary who, as such, is required to act in good faith with regard to the purposes of the trust and the interests of the beneficiaries. The holder of a power to direct is liable for any loss that results from breach of a fiduciary duty. 2. This section, while similar to Restatement section 185, features several important additions. a. First, subsection (a) makes it clear that, with respect to a revocable trust, the trustee may follow instructions of the settlor that are contrary to the terms of the trust instrument. b. Second, subsection (c) authorizes modification or termination of the trust by the trustee or another person, who presumably needs have no other relation to the trust. Query: how can the power to modify or terminate a trust be exercised “in good faith with regard to the purposes of the trust and the interests of the beneficiaries”? Should lawyers be drafting purpose clauses in all trusts? Unless the trust has a stated purpose or purposes, how can the power holder begin to determine whether any exercise of the power to modify or terminate is in good faith with respect to the purposes of the trust? c. Third, subsection (d) creates a statutory presumption that a person who has a power to direct the trustee holds such power in a fiduciary (not personal) capacity. I. Control and Protection of Trust Property. UTC § 809. 1. A trustee shall take reasonable steps to take control of and protect the trust property. 2. This provision consolidates in one section the duties imposed separately by Restatement sections 175 and 176. J. Record Keeping and Identification of Trust Property. UTC § 810. 1. (a) A trustee shall keep adequate records of the administration of the trust. (b) A trustee shall keep trust property separate from the trustee’s own property. (c) Except as otherwise provided in subsection (d), a trustee shall cause the trust property to be designated so that the interest of the trust, to the extent feasible, appears in records maintained by a party other than a trustee or beneficiary. (d) If the trustee maintains records clearly indicating the respective interests, a trustee may invest as a whole the property of two or more separate trusts. 2. The duty to maintain adequate records imposed by subsection (a) is similar to that imposed by Restatement section 172. 3. The duty to keep trust property separate imposed by subsection (b) is similar to that imposed by Restatement section 179. 4. Subsection (d) authorizes commingling of the property of several trusts, which is generally prohibited by Restatement section 179. K. Enforcement and Defense of Claims. UTC § 811. 1. A trustee shall take reasonable steps to enforce claims of the trust and to defend claims against the trust. 2. This section consolidates in one place the separate duties imposed by Restatement sections 177 and 178. L. Collecting Trust Property. UTC § 812. 1. A trustee shall take reasonable steps to compel a former trustee or other person to deliver trust property to the trustee, and to redress a breach of trust known to the trustee to have been committed by a former trustee. 2. The Restatement does not articulate this duty separately. However, it is contemplated by the Comments as part of the trustee’s duty to enforce claims under Restatement section 177. M. Duty to Inform and Report. UTC § 813. 1. (a) A trustee shall keep the qualified beneficiaries of the trust reasonably informed about the administration of the trust and of the material facts necessary for them to protect their interests. Unless unreasonable under the circumstances, a trustee shall promptly respond to a beneficiary’s request for information related to the administration of the trust. (b) A trustee: (1) upon request of a beneficiary, shall promptly furnish to the beneficiary a copy of the trust instrument; (2) within 60 days after accepting a trusteeship, shall notify the qualified beneficiaries of the acceptance and of the trustee’s name, address, and telephone number; (3) within 60 days after the date the trustee acquires knowledge of the creation of an irrevocable trust, or the date the trustee acquires knowledge that a formerly revocable trust has become irrevocable, whether by the death of the settlor or otherwise, shall notify the qualified beneficiaries of the trust’s existence, of the identity of the settlor or settlors, of the right to request a copy of the trust instrument, and of the right to a trustee’s report as provided in subsection (c); and (4) shall notify the qualified beneficiaries in advance of any change in the method or rate of the trustee’s compensation. (c) A trustee shall send to the distributees or permissible distributees of trust income or principal, and to other qualified or nonqualified beneficiaries who request it, at least annually and at the termination of the trust, a report of the trust property, liabilities, receipts, and disbursements, including the source and amount of the trustee’s compensation, a listing of the trust assets and, if feasible, their respective market values. Upon a vacancy in a trusteeship, unless a cotrustee remains in office, a report must be sent to the qualified ben- 28 ACTEC Journal 105 (2002) eficiaries by the former trustee. A personal representative, [conservator], or [guardian] may send the qualified beneficiaries a report on behalf of a deceased or incapacitated trustee. (d) A beneficiary may waive the right to a trustee’s report or other information otherwise required to be furnished under this section. A beneficiary, with respect to future reports and other information, may withdraw a waiver previously given. 2. UTC section 103(12) defines “qualified beneficiary” as “a beneficiary who, on the date the beneficiary’s qualification is determined: (A) is a distributee or permissible distributee of trust income or principal; (B) would be a distributee or permissible distributee of trust income or principal if the interests of the distributees described in subparagraph (A) terminated on that date; or (C) would be a distributee or permissible distributee of trust income or principal if the trust terminated on that date.” 3. Several of Professor English’s insights on this section are worthy of replication here: Philosophy. Section 813 of the UTC fills out and adds detail to the trustee’s duty to keep the beneficiaries informed of administration. When in doubt, the UTC favors disclosure to beneficiaries as the better policy. Specific Notice Requirements. The drafting committee rejected the more limited approach of letting the trustee decide which provisions are material to the beneficiary’s interest; the trustee’s version of what is material may differ markedly from what the beneficiary might find relevant. The Waiver Issue. The most discussed issued in the drafting of the UTC and subsequent to its approval is the extent to which the settlor may waive the requirements of Section 813. This issue is currently addressed in Section 105(b)(8)-(9). Most of the specific notice requirements are waivable. Not waivable is the trustee’s obligation to notify the qualified beneficiaries age 25 or older of the existence of the trust. With respect to any beneficiary regardless of age, the trustee [settlor?] also may not waive the trustee’s obligation to respond to a request for trustee’s report and other information reasonably related to the trust’s administration. In other words, if a beneficiary finds out about the trust and makes a request for information, the trustee must respond to the request even if the trustee was not obligated to inform the beneficiary about the trust in the first instance.1 English, David M., “The Uniform Trust Code (2000),” ACTEC 2000 Summer Meeting at 31. 28 ACTEC Journal 106 (2002) IV. DUTIES OF A TRUSTEE UNDER THE RESTATEMENT A. Duty to administer the trust. Restatement § 169. [Restatement text (but not Comments) throughout this outline is quoted in small capital letters.] 1. UPON ACCEPTANCE OF THE TRUST BY THE TRUSTEE, HE IS UNDER A DUTY TO THE BENEFICIARY TO ADMINISTER THE TRUST. 2. This section seems not to have attracted much attention from the courts. However, as both the Restatement Comment and Scott point out, this section prohibits a trustee from disclaiming his office after acceptance. Further, a trustee can only resign with the permission of the court or by the consent of all the beneficiaries, unless the terms of the trust provide otherwise. Scott § 169 at 311. Moreover, after acceptance, the trustee is bound to administer the trust even if he is to receive no compensation. However, this section makes it clear that a trustee’s duties are not contractual in nature. B. Duty of loyalty. Restatement 3d § 170. 1. (1) THE TRUSTEE IS UNDER A DUTY TO THE BENEFICIARY TO ADMINISTER THE TRUST SOLELY IN THE INTEREST OF THE BENEFICIARIES. (2) THE TRUSTEE IN DEALING WITH A BENEFICIARY ON THE TRUSTEE’S OWN ACCOUNT IS UNDER A DUTY TO DEAL FAIRLY AND TO COMMUNICATE TO THE BENEFICIARY ALL MATERIAL FACTS IN CONNECTION WITH THE TRANSACTION. 2. It is probably fair to say that more has been written about this duty of the trustee, both by the courts and by commentators, than any other. This is due to the fact that “The most fundamental duty owed by the trustee to the beneficiaries of the trust is the duty of loyalty.” Scott § 170 at 311. Implicit in the duty of loyalty is the duty not to self- deal. 3. In cases involving a breach of the duty of loyalty, it is typically immaterial that the trustee acted in good faith or that the particular transaction was fair and reasonable in all respects. 4. Prior court approval of a self-dealing transaction can avoid a breach of the duty of loyalty. Also, acquiescence or consent by the beneficiaries to a self-dealing transaction may constitute a defense if the beneficiaries were aware of all of the facts. C. Duty with respect to delegation. Restatement 3d § 171. 1. A TRUSTEE HAS A DUTY PERSONALLY TO PERFORM THE RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE TRUSTEESHIP EXCEPT AS A PRUDENT PERSON MIGHT DELEGATE THOSE RESPONSIBILITIES TO OTHERS. IN DECIDING WHETHER, TO WHOM AND IN WHAT MANNER TO DELEGATE FIDUCIARY AUTHORITY IN THE ADMINISTRATION OF A TRUST, AND THEREAFTER IN SUPERVISING AGENTS, THE TRUSTEE IS UNDER A DUTY TO THE BENEFICIARIES TO EXERCISE FIDUCIARY DISCRETION AND TO ACT AS A PRUDENT PERSON WOULD ACT IN SIMILAR CIRCUMSTANCES. 2. This section was substantially revised from Restatement section 171, which generally frowned on delegation. However, some delegation was permitted. As Comment d to former Restatement section 171 stated: A trustee can properly delegate the performance of acts which it is unreasonable to require him personally to perform. There is no clear-cut line dividing the acts which a trustee can properly delegate from those which he cannot properly delegate. In considering what acts a trustee can properly delegate the following circumstances, among others, may be of importance: (1) the amount of discretion involved, (2) the value and character of the property involved, (3) whether the property is income or principal, (4) the proximity or remoteness of the subject matter of the trust; (5) the character of the act as one involving professional skill or facilities possessed or not possessed by the trustee himself. 3. The philosophy of Restatement 3d section 171 is expressed in Comment f: Delegation of authority to do particular acts. Although the administration of a trust may not be delegated in full, a trustee may for many purposes delegate fiduciary authority to properly selected and supervised agents. Delegation is not limited to the performance of ministerial acts. In appropriate circumstances delegation may extend, for example, to discretionary acts, to the selection of trust investments or the management of specialized investment programs, and to other activities of administration involving significant judgment. ... In considering whether and under what circumstances and conditions a particular delegation of fiduciary authority is proper, the following circumstances, among others, may be of importance to the trustee or to a reviewing court: (1) the nature and degree of discretion involved; (2) the amount of funds or the value and character of the property involved; (3) efficiency, convenience, and cost considerations in light of the situs of the property or activities involved; (4) the relationship of the act or activities involved to the professional skills or facilities possessed by the trustee; and (5) the fairness and appropriateness of the responsibilities in question to the burdens and compensation of the trustee (see § 188, Comment c). 4. The terms of the trust instrument may authorize delegations of authority by the trustee that would otherwise be improper. Comment i. D. Duty to keep and render accounts. Restatement § 172. 1. THE TRUSTEE IS UNDER A DUTY TO THE BENEFICIARY TO KEEP AND RENDER CLEAR AND ACCURATE ACCOUNTS WITH RESPECT TO THE ADMINISTRATION OF THE TRUST. 2. Scott observes that a trustee’s “accounts should show what he has received and what he has expended. They should show what gains have accrued and what losses have been incurred on changes of investments. If the trust is created for beneficiaries in succession, the accounts should show what receipts and what expenditures are allocated to principal and what are allocated to income.” Scott § 172 at 452. 3. Not only must the trustee maintain accurate records. This section also imposes on a trustee the duty to provide an accounting at reasonable times when requested by the beneficiaries. a. The general rule is that a beneficiary who has only a future or contingent interest in the trust may still exercise the right to compel an accounting. However, several recent cases have held to the contrary. Chicago City Bank & Trust Co v. Lesman, 186 Ill App 3d 697, 134 Ill Dec 478, 542 NE 2d 1067 (1989); Schlosser v. Schlosser, 247 Ill App 3d 1044, 187 Ill Dec 769, 618 NE 2d 360, appeal denied, 152 Ill 2d 580, 190 Ill Dec 910, 622 NE 2d 1227 (1993). b. If only one beneficiary wants an accounting and the other beneficiaries object because of the cost to the trust, courts have held that the beneficiary requesting the accounting must indemnify the trust against the expense. In re New England Mutual Life Ins Co Litigation, 841 F Supp 345 (WD Wash 1994), aff’d mem, 54 F 3d 786 (9th Cir 1995); Bryan v. Seiffert, 185 Okla 496, 94 P 2d 526 (1939); Pollock v. Manufacturers & Traders Trust Co, 154 Misc 67, 276 NYS 363 (1934). 4. This duty is regulated by statute in many states. 28 ACTEC Journal 107 (2002) E. Duty to furnish information. Restatement § 173. 1. THE TRUSTEE IS UNDER A DUTY TO THE BENEFICIARY TO GIVE HIM UPON HIS REQUEST AT REASONABLE TIMES COMPLETE AND ACCURATE INFORMATION AS TO THE NATURE AND AMOUNT OF THE TRUST PROPERTY, AND TO PERMIT HIM OR A PERSON DULY AUTHORIZED BY HIM TO INSPECT THE SUBJECT MATTER OF THE TRUST AND THE ACCOUNTS AND VOUCHERS AND OTHER DOCUMENTS RELATING TO THE TRUST. 2. This duty requires a trustee to provide complete and accurate information regarding the administration of the trust. “The beneficiaries are entitled to know what the trust property is and how the trustee has dealt with it.” Scott § 173 at 462-464. 3. This topic generated considerable traffic on the ACTEC-GEN list-serve during November 2001. Fellows were interested in whether and how they might assist clients who preferred to keep the terms of a trust, or even its very existence, from being known by the beneficiaries. a. One Fellow mentioned that he was involved in a case where the trustees were accused of concealing the fact that a person was a potential beneficiary of the trust. Despite extraordinarily good investment performance, the remoteness of any possibility that a distribution would be made to the person involved, and no finding of bad faith, the trial court removed one corporate trustee and surcharged both the corporate and individual trustees. (Apparently the case is on appeal.) b. Also, in Karpf v. Karpf, 240 Neb 302, 481 NW 2d 891 (1992), where a statute mandated disclosure of the trust’s existence to the beneficiaries, the trustee’s failure to do so was held to be a breach of trust. c. Fellows seemed to conclude that the only way to keep a trust’s existence and terms from being known by the beneficiary is by using an offshore trust, the governing law of which might permit complete withholding of information. 4. According to Comment b, “The trustee is privileged to refrain from communicating to the beneficiary information acquired by the trustee at his own expense and for his own protection. Thus, he is privileged to refrain from communicating to the beneficiary opinions of counsel obtained by him at his own expense and for his own protection.” a. In Moeller v. Superior Court (Sanwa Bank), 947 P2d 279 (Cal 1997), the attorney-client privilege for confidential communications between a predecessor trustee and its counsel passed to the successor trustee. The court suggested that a trustee can avoid any problem resulting from such disclosure by retaining and paying counsel with his own funds for 28 ACTEC Journal 108 (2002) legal advice that is personal in nature. b. However, in Wells Fargo Bank, NA v. Superior Court, 990 P 2d 591 (Cal 2000), the court held that a trustee was not required to produce privileged communications on the subjects of trust administration and possible misconduct in order to fulfill its duties to report to the beneficiaries on the trust and its administration. The fact that the legal advice had been paid for by the trust apparently had no effect on the court’s decision. c. See generally, Report of the Special Study Committee on Professional Responsibility, Counseling the Fiduciary, 28 Real Prop, Prob & Trust J 825, 848-855 (1994); Hamel, Louis H., Jr., “Trustee’s Privileged Counsel: A Rebuttal,” 21 ACTEC Notes 156 (1995); Gibbs, Charles F. & Cindy D. Hanson, “The Fiduciary Exception to a Trustee’s Attorney/Client Privilege,” 21 ACTEC Notes 236 (1995); Gibbs, Charles F., “The Attorney/Client Privilege and the Fiduciary Exception–The Latest Word,” 21 ACTEC Notes 307 (1996); and Reid, Rust E., William R. Mureiko & D’Ana H. Mikeska, “Privilege and Confidentiality Issues When a Lawyer Represents a Fiduciary,” 30 Real Prop, Prob & Trust J 541 (Winter 1996). F. Duty to exercise reasonable care and skill. Restatement § 174. 1. THE TRUSTEE IS UNDER A DUTY TO THE BENEFICIARY IN ADMINISTERING THE TRUST TO EXERCISE SUCH CARE AND SKILL AS A MAN OF ORDINARY PRUDENCE WOULD EXERCISE IN DEALING WITH HIS OWN PROPERTY; AND IF THE TRUSTEE HAS OR PROCURES HIS APPOINTMENT AS TRUSTEE BY REPRESENTING THAT HE HAS GREATER SKILL THAN THAT OF A MAN OF ORDINARY PRUDENCE, HE IS UNDER A DUTY TO EXERCISE SUCH SKILL. 2. Note that the Restatement standard is that of a prudent person dealing with his own property. In many states that standard has been changed by statute to that of a prudent person dealing with the property of another. (UPC § 7-302 requires a trustee to observe the standards that would be observed by a prudent man dealing with the property of another.) 3. If a trustee has greater skills that those of an ordinary prudent person, he is under a duty to use those skills and will be liable for a loss resulting from a failure to use those skills. 4. Comment b states: “Whether the trustee is prudent in the doing of an act depends on the circumstances as they reasonably appear to him at the time when he does the act and not at some subsequent time when his conduct is called in question.” G. Duty to take and keep control. Restatement § 175. 1. THE TRUSTEE IS UNDER A DUTY TO THE BENEFICIARY TO TAKE REASONABLE STEPS TO TAKE AND KEEP CONTROL OF THE TRUST PROPERTY. 2. A trustee is ordinarily under a duty to take and keep possession of tangible personal property owned by the trust. a. This duty is sometimes ignored or overlooked when tangible personal property located in a residence, such as artwork, continues to remain in the residence occupied by the beneficiary. b. Proper drafting can make sure that the trustee’s duty to take and keep control of tangibles is waived for items the settlor intends for the beneficiary to use and enjoy. 3. This duty can lead to potential liability for the trustee, as under CERCLA. 4. Where reasonable to do so, the trustee may entrust possession of trust property to the trustee’s attorney, broker, banker, or other agent. Comment e. 5. This duty also includes the responsibility to designate property as trust property. H. Duty to preserve the trust property. Restatement § 176. 1. THE TRUSTEE IS UNDER A DUTY TO THE BENEFICIARY TO USE REASONABLE CARE AND SKILL TO PRESERVE THE TRUST PROPERTY. 2. Consistent with his duty to use appropriate care and skill, it is a trustee’s duty to protect the trust property from loss, damage, or other diminution in value. Examples include: a. Physical loss of trust property, such as loss of a stock certificate. b. Failure to procure appropriate insurance against casualty loss. c. Legal loss of trust property from failure to pay taxes or a mortgage. On the subject of a trustee’s duties to minimize taxes, see Ascher, Mark L., “The Fiduciary Duty to Minimize Taxes,” 20 Real Prop, Prob & Trust J 663 (1985). d. Loss in value from failure to make repairs necessary to preserve property. 3. If there are insufficient funds in the trust estate with which to pay expenses necessary to preserve the trust property, the trustee may: a. Raise the funds from the trust property by mortgage, sale, or otherwise; or, b. Notify the beneficiaries in order to give them the chance to advance the money. I. Duty to enforce claims. Restatement § 177. 1. THE TRUSTEE IS UNDER A DUTY TO THE BENEFICIARY TO TAKE REASONABLE STEPS TO REALIZE ON CLAIMS WHICH HE HOLDS IN TRUST. 2. This duty applies to: a. Claims against any predecessor trustee; b. Claims against the executor or personal representative of a decedent/trustor; c. Tort claims; and, d. Contract claims. 3. If a claim cannot be collected in full or it appears doubtful that it is enforceable, the trustee can compromise the claim or submit it to arbitration. 4. If it appears reasonable to do so, the trustee need not file suit or appeal an adverse lower court decision. J. Duty to defend actions. Restatement § 178. 1. THE TRUSTEE IS UNDER A DUTY TO THE BENEFICIARY TO DEFEND ACTIONS WHICH MAY RESULT IN A LOSS TO THE TRUST ESTATE, UNLESS UNDER ALL THE CIRCUMSTANCES IT IS REASONABLE NOT TO MAKE SUCH DEFENSE. 2. A trustee is obligated to appeal an adverse decision to a higher court, unless under all the circumstances it is unreasonable not to appeal. 3. A trustee can properly compromise or arbitrate claims against the trust if it appears to be for the benefit of the beneficiary. 4. A trustee can properly pay a claim, even though it appears not to be enforceable, if the cost and risk incurred in defending the claim are unreasonable. 5. Also, “It is the duty of the trustee to the beneficiaries of the trust to prevent the destruction of the trust. Thus, where the settlor or his successors in interest seek to rescind the trust on the ground that the settlor was induced by undue influence or mistake to create the trust, it is the duty of the trustee to defend the trust and resist the proceeding to the extent to which it is reasonable to require him to do so.” Scott § 178 at 496. K. Duty to keep trust property separate. Restatement § 179. 1. THE TRUSTEE IS UNDER A DUTY TO THE BENEFICIARY TO KEEP THE TRUST PROPERTY SEPARATE FROM HIS INDIVIDUAL PROPERTY, AND, SO FAR AS IT IS REASONABLE THAT HE SHOULD DO SO, TO KEEP IT SEPARATE FROM OTHER PROPERTY NOT SUBJECT TO THE TRUST, AND TO SEE THAT THE PROPERTY IS DESIGNATED AS PROPERTY OF THE TRUST. 2. This duty requires that the trustee: a. Keep the trust property separate from his own property; b. Keep the trust property separate from property held upon other trusts; and, c. Earmark the trust property as property of the trust. 3. Comment d states: The trust property should be ordinarily so earmarked as to indicate not only that it is trust property but that it is property of the particular trust upon which it is held. Thus, it is ordinarily not sufficient that the 28 ACTEC Journal 109 (2002) trustee should take title to the property in the name of the trustee “as trustee” without indicating the particular trust upon which it is held. It should be taken in the name of the trustee as “trustee under the will of” the settlor, or “as trustee under a certain deed of trust” or “as trustee for” certain beneficiaries. 4. However, the terms of the trust instrument may authorize the trustee to hold the trust property in his own name without designating the particular trust or even that it is held in trust at all. Therefore, absent statutory authority (which now exists in most states), if securities are to be held in street name with a brokerage house, the trust instrument must permit the trustee to hold trust property in the name of a third person and to register trust securities in the name of a nominee. 5. Commingling assets of various trusts is generally impermissible under this section. L. Duty with respect to bank deposits. Restatement § 180. 1. WHILE A TRUSTEE CAN PROPERLY MAKE GENERAL DEPOSITS OF TRUST MONEY IN A BANK, IT IS HIS DUTY TO THE BENEFICIARY IN MAKING SUCH A DEPOSIT TO USE REASONABLE CARE IN SELECTING THE BANK, AND PROPERLY TO EARMARK THE DEPOSIT AS A DEPOSIT BY HIM AS TRUSTEE. 2. Scott observes that “A trustee cannot properly lend trust money without security. In a sense a deposit in a bank is a loan to the bank of the money deposited.” Scott § 180 at 526. However, if a deposit is insured by a federal agency, it is not improper as an unsecured loan. Id at 539. (See Note, “The Responsibilities of a Lawyer or Fiduciary with Respect to Estate Funds over the Amount Insured by the FDIC,” 7 Conn Prob LJ 183 (1992).) 3. Nevertheless, a trustee can deposit funds in a bank, subject to the trustee’s responsibility to exercise reasonable care and skill. Those responsibilities extend to selection of the bank, earmarking any deposits, not leaving funds uninvested for too long, and not precluding withdrawals. M. Duty to make the trust property productive. Restatement 3d § 181. 1. THE TRUSTEE IS UNDER A DUTY TO THE BENEFICIARIES TO USE REASONABLE CARE AND SKILL TO MAKE THE TRUST PROPERTY PRODUCTIVE IN A MANNER THAT IS CONSISTENT WITH THE FIDUCIARY DUTIES OF CAUTION AND IMPARTIALITY. 2. Comment a to this revised section states: Productivity generally. A trustee is normally under a duty to manage trust 28 ACTEC Journal 110 (2002) property so that the trust estate can reasonably be expected to produce a total return that is consistent with objectives of caution and impartiality as appropriate to the particular trust and its purposes, requirements, and circumstances. ... The objectives of total return encompass not only income productivity but also returns to principal, with these competing interests being balanced in a way that is appropriate to the particular trust. The principal objectives involve preservation of the corpus, which normally includes a general goal of protecting its purchasing power (that is, protection of real rather than merely dollar value). In some trusts these objectives may even support a goal of enhancing real value. Fulfillment of a trust’s combination of income and principal objectives, of course, need not be assured by the trustee’s investment program. The ability to realize these dual objectives will be particularly uncertain over any given period of time, and most notably with respect to principal objectives. Thus, the duties of the trustee require a careful balancing of objectives and uncertainties, taking account of the particular trust’s tolerance for volatility and other risks and after giving due consideration to the goals and circumstances of that trust. 3. The cited Comment makes it clear that productivity applies not only to income but also to principal. Moreover, productivity involves the concept of total return. Also, preservation of the value of principal now involves protecting the trust’s purchasing power in real terms. 4. Land. Formerly, a trustee was normally required to lease land or manage it to produce income. However, under Restatement 3d section 181, “Questions of income productivity and impartiality are properly judged on the basis of the trust estate as a whole rather than asset by asset.” Comment b. Thus, the manner in which and the degree to which land must be made productive depends on the purposes for which the property is held. “Similarly, the existence, extent, and nature of the trustee’s duty with respect to produc- tivity of land are affected by whether the land is improved and, if not, by the prospects of its being leased or otherwise used productively in light of the trustee’s possible authority to make improvements and the realistic prospect of those improvements being made.” Id. 5. Chattels. Unless the trust instrument requires the trustee to preserve, distribute, or utilize chattels (as in a business), the trustee has a duty to sell or lease chattels. However, it may be proper for the trustee to hold tangibles as part of the trust’s investment portfolio. Comment c. 6. Money. A trustee is normally required to invest money so that it will produce income. However, reasonable delays in investing are permitted. Comment d. N. Duty to pay income to beneficiary. Restatement § 182. 1. WHERE A TRUST IS CREATED TO PAY THE INCOME TO A BENEFICIARY FOR A DESIGNATED PERIOD, THE TRUSTEE IS UNDER A DUTY TO THE BENEFICIARY TO PAY TO HIM AT REASONABLE INTERVALS THE NET INCOME OF THE TRUST PROPERTY. 2. “The trustee can properly withhold a reasonable amount of the income to meet present or anticipated expenses which are properly chargeable to income.” Comment a. “In order to equalize the income from year to year he may estimate in advance probable expenditures and build up a reserve to meet such expenditures.” Scott § 182 at 551. 3. Trust provisions mandating accumulation of income for a period longer than any applicable rule against perpetuities are invalid. Restatement § 62, Comment t. 4. Beneficiary under an incapacity. Scott § 182 at 552-555. a. The trustee’s duty depends on the terms of the trust instrument. If the trust instrument requires payment of income, it is the trustee’s duty to pay the income to the beneficiary’s guardian or conservator or to the court. (However, if the trustee applies the income for the support of the beneficiary, he will be entitled to credit in his accounting, because otherwise the beneficiary would be unjustly enriched.) b. If the trust instrument authorizes the trustee to apply the income for the benefit of the incapacitated beneficiary, the trustee can do so without paying the income to the beneficiary’s guardian. c. If the trustee is directed to apply the income for the benefit of an incapacitated beneficiary, he may not pay the income to the beneficiary’s guardian, because that would be an improper delegation of the trustee’s duties. d. But see UTC section 816(21), which gives the trustee the authority to pay any amount dis- tributable to a beneficiary who is under a legal disability by paying it directly, applying it for the beneficiary’s benefit, by paying it to the beneficiary’s conservator (or, if none, guardian), a custodian under the Uniform Transfers to Minors Act or custodial trustee under the Uniform Custodial Trust Act (and for such purpose to create either one), an adult relative or other person who has physical custody of the beneficiary, or by managing it as a separate fund. O. Duty to deal impartially with beneficiaries. Restatement 3d § 183. 1. WHERE THERE ARE TWO OR MORE BENEFICIARIES OF A TRUST, THE TRUSTEE IS UNDER A DUTY TO DEAL IMPARTIALLY WITH THEM. 2. This duty applies whether the interests of the beneficiaries are simultaneous or successive. Comment a. 3. The trust instrument may authorize the trustee to favor the interests of one beneficiary over another. Id. P. Duty with respect to co-trustees. Restatement 3d § 184. 1. IF THERE ARE SEVERAL TRUSTEES, EACH TRUSTEE IS UNDER A DUTY TO THE BENEFICIARIES TO PARTICIPATE IN THE ADMINISTRATION OF THE TRUST AND TO USE REASONABLE CARE TO PREVENT A CO-TRUSTEE FROM COMMITTING A BREACH OF TRUST, AND IF NECESSARY TO COMPEL A CO-TRUSTEE TO REDRESS A BREACH OF TRUST. 2. Generally, it is improper for one trustee to allow a co-trustee to have such control of the trust property as would enable that co-trustee to misappropriate it. Comment a. That is why, unless it is proper to hold securities in the name of a nominee, trust property should be titled or registered in the names of all of the trustees. 3. “Where there are several trustees, unless the terms of the trust or of an applicable statute provide otherwise, action by all of them is necessary to the exercise of powers conferred upon them.” Comment b. (See Uniform Trustee Powers Act.) 4. The trust instrument may authorize one or more (but fewer than all) trustees to have possession or control of trust property or to perform specific functions. Q. Duty with respect to person holding power of control. Restatement § 185. 1. IF UNDER THE TERMS OF THE TRUST A PERSON HAS POWER TO CONTROL THE ACTION OF THE TRUSTEE IN CERTAIN RESPECTS, THE TRUSTEE IS UNDER A DUTY TO ACT IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE EXERCISE OF SUCH POWER, UNLESS THE ATTEMPTED EXERCISE OF THE POWER VIOLATES THE TERMS OF THE TRUST OR IS A VIOLATION OF A FIDUCIARY DUTY TO WHICH SUCH PERSON IS SUBJECT IN THE EXERCISE OF THE POWER. 2. The person holding the power to control 28 ACTEC Journal 111 (2002) the actions of the trustee may be a co- trustee, a beneficiary, the settlor, or a third person otherwise unconnected with the trust. 3. The trustee’s duty under this section depends on whether the person who possesses the power holds it in a purely personal capacity or in a fiduciary capacity. a. Power held personally. “Where the holder of the power holds it solely for his own benefit, the trustee can properly comply and is under a duty to comply with his directions, provided that the attempted exercise of the power does not violate the terms of the trust.” Scott § 185 at 574. b. Power held as a fiduciary. “But where the holder of the power holds it as a fiduciary, the trustee is not justified in complying with his directions if the trustee knows or ought to know that the holder of the power is violating his duty to the beneficiaries as fiduciary in giving the directions.” Id. The trustee is under a duty to take reasonable steps to inquire whether the power holder is violating his fiduciary duty to the beneficiaries. c. See discussion of UTC § 808(b) supra. V. EXCULPATORY PROVISIONS A. In general. 1. Exculpatory clauses are also sometimes referred to as “immunity” clauses. 2. Professor Bogert describes two types of exculpatory clauses: a. “One provides that the trustee is not to be accountable to anyone for his actions. This type of clause is not upheld.” Bogert, George Gleason & George Taylor Bogert, The Law of Trusts and Trustees § 542 (2d ed 1979) at 188. b. “The second type of exculpatory clause provides that the trustee is not to be liable for specified acts or certain conduct.” Id. at 189. 3. Professor Bogert also observes that “It would doubtless be regarded as against public policy to excuse a trustee from liability for the consequences of willful negligence or default, or bad faith or gross negligence.” [Footnote omitted.] Id. at 208. 4. Exculpatory clauses are strictly construed by the courts. In Re Trusteeship of Williams, 591 NW 2d 743 (Minn Ct App 1999). B. UTC. 1. Exculpation of Trustee. UTC § 1008. (a) A term of the trust relieving the trustee of liability for breach of trust is unenforceable to the extent that it: (1) relieves the trustee of liability for breach of trust committed in bad faith or with reckless indifference to the purposes of the trust or the interests of the beneficiaries; or 28 ACTEC Journal 112 (2002) (2) was inserted as the result of an abuse by the trustee of a fiduciary or confidential relationship to the settlor. (b) An exculpatory term drafted or caused to be drafted by the trustee is invalid as an abuse of a fiduciary or confidential relationship unless the trustee proves that the exculpatory term is fair under the circumstances and that its existence and contents were adequately communicated to the settlor. 2. Note, however, that under UTC section 105(10), the terms of the trust instrument cannot prevail over the effect of an exculpatory term under this section. 3. Whether an exculpatory term has been “drafted or caused to be drafted by the trustee” is sure to spawn litigation. a. If a professional fiduciary refers a prospective trust customer to an estate planning attorney who drafts a trust, has any exculpatory term in the trust instrument been “caused to be drafted by the trustee”? b. Regardless of how the client comes to the estate planning lawyer, if that lawyer uses the professional fiduciary’s trust form and the trust instrument names as trustee the professional fiduciary whose form was used, was any exculpatory provision “caused to be drafted by the trustee”? 4. How will a trustee ever prove that an exculpatory term is “fair under the circumstances”? a. “Fair” to whom? Presumably, it will be fairness to the beneficiaries that will be the test. That presents a serious problem for any trustee, because it would seem that an exculpatory provision would never be fair to the beneficiaries if the alternative is that the beneficiaries would have a cause of action against the trustee for breach of trust. b. What “circumstances”? When are the circumstances to be determined? Are they the circumstances at the time the trust is created? Or are they the circumstances at the time when what would otherwise be a breach of trust occurs? 5. How will the trustee ever prove that the “existence and contents” of an exculpatory provision were adequately communicated to the settlor? a. Should exculpatory provisions be separately identified and initialed by the settlor? b. What is the drafting attorney’s responsibility to the trustee, if any, for ensuring that the existence and contents of an exculpatory term were adequately disclosed? 6. Note also that UTC section 1106 contemplates that the UTC will apply to all trusts created before, on, or after enactment in a particular state. It is not clear if and how the limited exceptions to retroac- tivity might apply to exculpatory clauses and acts performed in reliance thereon. C. Restatement. 1. In general, the trustee can be relieved of liability for a breach of trust by use of an exculpatory provision in the trust instrument. Restatement § 222. 2. However, an exculpatory provision cannot relieve the trustee of liability: a. For a breach of trust committed in bad faith; b. For a breach of trust committed intentionally; c. For a breach of trust committed with reckless indifference to the interest of the beneficiary; or d. For any profit which the trustee derives from a breach of trust. Id. 3. An exculpatory provision is ineffective to the extent inserted in the instrument as the result of the trustee’s abuse of a fiduciary or confidential relationship to the settlor. Id. 4. Furthermore, exculpatory provisions are strictly construed. Id., Comment a. VI. FIDUCIARY BONDS A. In general. 1. “A fiduciary bond is a signed promise to be personally responsible for carrying out certain obligations. It neither increases nor decreases the trustee’s general fiduciary responsibility nor does it affect the trustee’s liability. … It may be appropriate to have a surety on the bond. A surety is either an individual or a company who agrees to be responsible (up to the dollar limits specified in the bond) in the event the beneficiary cannot be made whole in an action against the trustee. Surety fees are a proper trust expense generally charged to trust income.” [Footnote omitted.] Rounds, Charles E., Jr., Loring A Trustee’s Handbook (1999 ed., Panel Publishers) § 3.5.4.3 at 73. 2. Most states now have statutes that obviate the need for a trustee to file a bond. See Bogert, George Gleason & George Taylor Bogert, The Law of Trusts and Trustees § 151 (2d ed 1979). B. UTC. 1. Trustee’s Bond. UTC § 702. (a) A trustee shall give bond to secure performance of the trustee’s duties only if the court finds that a bond is needed to protect the interests of the beneficiaries or is required by the terms of the trust and the court has not dispensed with the requirement. (b) The court may specify the amount of a bond, its liabilities, and whether sureties are necessary. The court may modify or terminate a bond at any time. [(c) A regulated financial-service institution qualified to do business in this State need not give bond, even if required by the terms of the trust.] 2. Thus, if the trust instrument is silent on the issue, under the UTC no bond is required of the trustee unless the court finds it necessary to protect the interests of the beneficiaries. Query: if the trust instrument is silent on the issue of bond, does a new trustee have any duty to bring the issue to the attention of a court of competent jurisdiction? C. Restatement. The Restatement is essentially silent on the subject of a fidelity bond. Its only reference is in Comment b to § 107 where a trustee’s refusal to give bond, if required, is grounds for removal. VII. TYPES OF LIABILITY A. Personal liability. “A person is subject to personal liability if an action can be maintained against him as an individual and his individual property can be subjected by judicial proceedings to the satisfaction of a judgment entered therein.” Restatement § 261, Comment a. B. Liability in a representative capacity. “If a person is subject to liability only in a representative capacity, an action cannot be maintained against him as an individual and his individual property cannot be reached by judicial process, but only such property as he holds in his representative capacity can be reached.” Id. VIII. TRUSTEE’S RIGHT TO INDEMNITY FROM THE TRUST ESTATE A. General rules. 1. THE TRUSTEE IS ENTITLED TO INDEMNITY OUT OF THE TRUST ESTATE FOR EXPENSES PROPERLY INCURRED BY HIM IN THE ADMINISTRATION OF THE TRUST. Restatement § 244. a. The right to indemnity applies to expenses incurred in: (1) Defending suits to set aside the trust, to terminate the trust prematurely, and to remove the trustee without justification. (2) Defending or prosecuting actions for the benefit of the trust, where the litigation is not the trustee’s fault. (3) Obtaining the advice of counsel to aid in the administration of the trust, where such advice is not required as a result of the trustee’s own fault. (4) Making repairs or improvements to trust property or paying commissions in connection with the sale of trust property. (5) Employing agents. Scott § 244 at 324-25. b. A trustee’s right to indemnity may 28 ACTEC Journal 113 (2002) take the form of exoneration or reimbursement. Restatement § 244, Comment b. What is the right of indemnity? I apprehend that in equity, at all events, it is not a right of the trustee to be indemnified only after he has made the necessary payments…but that he is entitled to be indemnified, not merely against the payments actually made, but against his liability…. It seems to me, therefore, that a trustee has a right to resort in the first instance to the trust estate to enable him to make the necessary payments to the person whom he employs to assist him in the administration of the trust estate; that he is not bound in the first instance to pay those persons out of his own pocket, and then recoup himself out of the trust estate, but that he can properly in the first instance resort to the trust estate, and pay those persons whom he has properly employed the proper remuneration out of the trust estate. In re Blundell, 40 Ch D 370, 376 (1888), 44 Ch D 1 (1889); cited at Scott § 244 at 32728. (1) Exoneration is the use of trust property to discharge the liability in the first instance so that the trustee will not be forced to use his individual property. Restatement § 244, Comment b. (2) Reimbursement is repayment of the trustee for use of his personal funds to discharge a liability. Id. c. The trustee has a security interest in the trust property to the extent he is entitled to indemnity. Id., Comment c. d. The rule applies even to spendthrift trusts. Id., Comment d. e. Any liability of the trustee for breach of trust can be set off against the amount to which he would otherwise be entitled for indemnity. Id., Comment e. 2. With the exceptions described below, the trustee is not entitled to indemnity for his expenses from the trust if those expenses were not properly incurred. Restatement § 245. a. The trustee is not entitled to indemnity for expenses in employing an agent to perform acts which the trustee ought to perform personally. Id., Comment b. b. The terms of the trust may permit the 28 ACTEC Journal 114 (2002) trustee to be indemnified by the trust estate for expenses incurred in good faith even though he is not empowered to incur such expenses. The expenses, however, must not have been incurred in bad faith or with reckless indifference to the interest of the beneficiary. Id., Comment c. 3. “The trustee is entitled to indemnity for expenses not properly incurred by him if and to the extent to which he has thereby in good faith benefitted the trust estate.” Scott § 245.1 at 338. a. This exception requires that the trustee act in good faith and that there be a benefit to the trust estate. (1) However, under certain circumstances it may be inequitable to the beneficiary to permit the trustee to be indemnified. Those circumstances include: (a) “[W]hether the trustee acted in bad faith in incurring the expense. (b) “[W]hether the trustee in incurring the expense knew that he was not empowered to incur it. (c) “[W]hether in incurring the expense he reasonably believed that it was necessary to do so for the preservation of the trust estate. (d) “[W]hether the benefit has been or can be realized in the form of money. (e) “[W]hether indemnity can be allowed without defeating or impairing the purposes of the trust.” Restatement § 245, Comment g. (2) Such benefit to the trust estate may take the form of an increase in rental value or sales value of the trust property. Id., Comment e. (3) A benefit may also result from preservation of value that would otherwise have been diminished. Id, Comment f. (4) The trustee may have to wait for indemnity until the benefit he conferred has been realized. Id., Comment g. b. “If such indemnity were not allowed, the beneficiary would be unjustly enriched at the expense of the trustee.” Id., Comment d. 4. “If the trustee exceeds his powers in incurring an expense, with the result that the trust estate is benefitted thereby, but in such a manner that the beneficiaries are in a position to accept or reject the benefit, the trustee is entitled to indemnity for the amount of expense incurred if, but only if, the beneficiaries accept the benefit.” Scott § 245.2 at 344. If the beneficiaries decline the benefit, the trustee is not entitled to indemnity but is entitled to take the benefit. Restatement § 245, Comment i. B. Indemnity for contractual liability. 1. The general rules discussed above with respect to indemnity of the trustee apply in the area of contractual liability. Restatement § 246. Thus, if a contractual liability is properly incurred by the trustee in the administration of the trust, the trustee is entitled to indemnity. If the expense is not properly incurred, the rules under Restatement § 245 apply. 2. “Although the trustee breaks a contract properly made by him in the administration of the trust and thereby incurs a liability for breach of contract, he is entitled to indemnity to the extent to which he thereby benefitted the trust estate.” Restatement § 246, Comment c. C. Indemnity for tort liability. 1. The general rules discussed above with respect to indemnity of the trustee also apply in the area of liability in tort. Restatement § 247. a. If a tort liability occurs in the proper administration of the trust, and the trustee was not personally at fault in incurring the liability, the trustee is entitled to indemnity. Id., Comment a. b. Where tort liability to a third person results from the act of the trustee’s properly employed agent, the trustee is entitled to indemnity so long as the trustee was not personally at fault. Id. c. “If the trustee was at fault in incurring the liability, he is not entitled to indemnity.” Id., Comment d. 2. If by failing to obtain liability insurance the trustee has committed a breach of trust, he is not entitled to indemnity to the extent the insurance he should have obtained would have discharged the liability. Id., Comment e. 3. A trustee may be entitled to indemnity from the trust estate for liability incurred from commission of an intentional tort. Id., Comment g. a. The trustee must have intended that the intentional tort would benefit the trust estate. Id. b. The intentional tort must have actually benefitted the trust estate. Id. c. The trustee’s claim of indemnity is still limited by the amount of benefit conferred upon the trust estate, and indemnity must not be inequitable under the circumstances. Id., Restatement § 245(2). D. Indemnity for liability as a title holder of property. 1. The general rules discussed above with respect to indemnity of the trustee apply by reason of holding title to the trust property. Restatement § 248. 2. “If the trustee in breach of trust acquires or holds property, he is not entitled to indemnity for liabilities incurred by him as holder of the title, unless the beneficiary elects to take the property.” Id., Comment d. “Thus if a trustee of shares of stock improperly takes the shares in his individual name so that he becomes individually liable to pay calls or assessments with respect to the shares, he is entitled to indemnity, since the ulti- mate result would have been the same even if he had properly taken the shares in his name as trustee. But if the trustee purchases shares that he is not authorized to purchase, and as a result he is compelled to pay an assessment or call upon the shares, the beneficiary may reject the shares and the trustee is not entitled to indemnity. But if the beneficiary accepts the shares he must accept the burdens with the benefits and the trustee will be entitled to indemnity.” Scott § 248 at 351. E. Indemnity where trust estate is insufficient. 1. “In the case of a testamentary trust and ordinarily in the case of a trust created inter vivos, the trustee is not entitled to indemnity from the beneficiary personally in the absence of an agreement to the contrary.” Restatement § 249, Comment a. 2. However, there are two exceptions to this rule. a. If there was an agreement between the trustee and the beneficiary that the beneficiary would indemnify the trustee, then the trustee is entitled to indemnity from the beneficiary personally. Restatement § 249, Comment b. (1) Such agreement can be expressed in specific terms or may be inferred from all the circumstances. Id. (2) Circumstances among those that may tend to evidence such an agreement are: (a) “[T]hat the settlor is also the sole beneficiary or one of the beneficiaries, (b) “[T]he duty of the trustee was not merely to care for the trust property but to conduct a business involving considerable risk on the part of the trustee, and (c) “[T]hat the trust property was shares of stock involving a possibility of calls or assessments which might exceed the value of the shares.” Id. (d) An agreement regarding indemnity between the beneficiary and the trustee is normally interpreted as applying only to liabilities incurred in the proper administration of the trust. Id. b. Likewise, if the trustee has distributed property to the beneficiary without deducting the amount to which he is entitled as indemnity, he is entitled to indemnity from the beneficiary personally to the extent of the property so conveyed. Restatement § 249(2). (1) This rule does not apply if the trustee has indicated his intent to forego any claim to indemnity. Id. (2) Nor does this rule apply if the beneficiary has so changed his position that it is inequitable to require him to indemnify the trustee. Id. (3) Although neither the Restatement nor Scott speaks to this point, it would appear that 28 ACTEC Journal 115 (2002) the trustee’s delay in seeking indemnity from the beneficiaries personally could result in his being estopped from making a claim for indemnity. Similarly, delay by the trustee is the single factor most likely to allow the beneficiary to change his position, thereby rendering indemnification inequitable. Query: is a refunding provision incorporated in a trustee’s instrument of distribution or the beneficiary’s receipt and release sufficient to preserve the trustee’s right to indemnity from the beneficiary personally, despite the passage of what otherwise would be considered an inordinate time? (4) “If the trust property would be insufficient to indemnify the trustee, he is not under a duty to incur a liability unless the beneficiaries are willing to indemnify him.” Scott § 249.1 at 358. IX. LIABILITY OF THE TRUSTEE TO THIRD PERSONS A. Personal liability to third persons. THE TRUSTEE IS SUBJECT TO PERSONAL LIABILITY TO THIRD PERSONS ON OBLIGATIONS INCURRED IN THE ADMINISTRATION OF THE TRUST TO THE SAME EXTENT THAT HE WOULD BE LIABLE IF HE HELD THE PROPERTY FREE OF TRUST. Restatement § 261. 1. The rule applies to the three typical ways (listed below) in which obligations to third persons generally arise in the administration of a trust. However, it also applies to other liabilities incurred in the administration of the trust. Id., Comment c. a. Contracts made by the trustee. b. Torts committed by the trustee. c. Ownership of the property held in trust. 2. “Although the trustee is personally liable to third persons on obligations incurred by him in the administration of the trust, he is entitled to indemnity out of the trust estate if the liability was properly incurred by him.” Restatement § 261, Comment b. 3. Note, however, that this general rule may be limited or negated by statute. See UPC § 7-306. B. Contract liability. EXCEPT AS STATED IN § 263, THE TRUSTEE IS SUBJECT TO PERSONAL LIABILITY UPON CONTRACTS MADE BY HIM IN THE COURSE OF THE ADMINISTRATION OF THE TRUST. Restatement § 262. 1. “Where a trustee in the administration of the trust makes a contract with a third person, the trustee is personally liable on the contract in the absence of a stipulation in the contract relieving him from personal liability.” Scott § 262 at 418. “Thus, even if the third party knows that the contract was made by the trustee in the administration and for the benefit of the trust, the trustee is personally liable.” Id. at 420-21. 2. This rule applies whether or not the trustee is properly performing his duties when he enters into 28 ACTEC Journal 116 (2002) the contract. Restatement § 262, Comment a. 3. The trustee’s personal liability does not depend on whether the existence of the trust or the names of the beneficiaries are known to the third party. Id. 4. If the liability was properly incurred by the trustee in the administration of the trust, he is entitled to indemnity from the trust. Restatement § 246. However, the trustee remains personally liable even if the trust estate is insufficient to indemnify him, unless the contract expressly or impliedly provides otherwise. Restatement § 262, Comment b. 5. UPC section 7-306(a) significantly limits the trustee’s liability in contract: “Unless otherwise provided in the contract, a trustee is not personally liable on contracts properly entered into in his fiduciary capacity in the course of administration of the trust estate unless he fails to reveal his representative capacity and identify the trust estate in the contract. The Comment to UPC section 7-306 indicates that the purpose of the section is to make the liability of the trust and the trustee the same as that of a decedent’s estate and its personal representative. C. Tort liability. THE TRUSTEE IS SUBJECT TO PERSONAL LIABILITY TO THIRD PERSONS FOR TORTS COMMITTED IN THE COURSE OF THE ADMINISTRATION OF THE TRUST TO THE SAME EXTENT THAT HE WOULD BE LIABLE IF HE HELD THE PROPERTY FREE OF TRUST. Restatement § 264. 1. This rule applies regardless of whether the tort was intentional or negligent or whether the trustee was without fault, whether his conduct was an action or inaction, and whether or not he violated any duty as trustee. Id., Comment a. 2. The principle of respondeat superior applies to torts committed by agents or employees of the trustee. Restatement § 264, Comment b. 3. If the liability was properly incurred by the trustee in the administration of the trust, he is entitled to indemnity from the trust. Restatement § 247. However, the trustee remains personally liable even if the trust estate is insufficient to indemnify him. Restatement § 264, Comment c. 4. It is possible that breach of fiduciary duty may itself become an independent tort. See Hartlove v. Maryland School for the Blind, 111 Md App 310, 681 A 2d 584 (1996), citing the Restatement of the Law (Second) Torts § 874. 5. UPC section 7-306(b) significantly limits the trustee’s liability in tort: “A trustee is personally liable…for torts committed in the course of administration of the trust estate only if he is personally at fault.” D. Property liability. WHERE A LIABILITY TO THIRD PERSONS IS IMPOSED UPON A PERSON, NOT AS A RESULT OF THE CONTRACT MADE BY HIM OR A TORT COMMITTED BY HIM BUT BECAUSE HE IS THE HOLDER OF THE TITLE TO PROPERTY, A TRUSTEE AS A HOLDER OF THE TITLE TO THE TRUST PROPERTY IS SUBJECT TO PERSONAL LIABILITY, BUT ONLY TO THE EXTENT TO WHICH THE TRUST ESTATE IS SUFFICIENT TO INDEMNIFY HIM. Restatement § 265. 1. Unless and to the extent otherwise provided by the trust instrument, a trustee is entitled to indemnity from the trust property for expenses properly incurred in the administration of the trust. Restatement § 244. Liabilities incurred by reason of the trustee’s holding title to property are within the scope of the right to indemnity. Restatement § 248. 2. However, unlike the unlimited personal liability to third parties for the trustee’s contracts and torts, the trustee’s liability to third parties arising from holding title to trust property is generally limited to the extent to which the trust estate is sufficient to indemnify him. Restatement § 265, Comment a. a. This rule applies to property taxes. Restatement § 265, Comment b. b. It also applies to assessments on shareholders, if the shares are registered in the name of the person as trustee. Restatement § 265, Comment c. c. The most financially devastating area in which this type of liability is not limited to the value of the trust estate has recently arisen is environmental liability under the Comprehensive Environmental Response, Compensation, and Liability Act of 1980, 42 USC §§ 9601 et seq. (“CERCLA”). See generally Packer, Thomas A. & James W. Miller, Jr., “Inheritance of Contaminated Property: Blessing or Curse?,” 10 Prob & Prop 13 (Oct/Nov. 1996) [hereinafter cited as “Packer”]; Note, “The Expansive Reach of CERCLA Liability: Potential Liability of Executors of Wills and Inter Vivos and Testamentary Trustees,” 55 Albany L Rev. 143 (1991). (1) Under CERCLA § 9607(a), liability is imposed on four classes of persons: (a) Current owners or operators of contaminated property; (b) Owners or operators of the property at the time when hazardous waste disposal occurs; (c) Persons who arrange for disposal or treatment of hazardous substances at the property; and, (d) Persons who accepted hazardous substances for transport to the property. (2) “Just as an executor or conservator’s CERCLA liability is typically limited to estate assets, a trustee’s liability is typically limited to trust assets. See Restatement §§ 264, 265. The trustee’s personal liability will turn on whether the trustee is a ‘responsible person’ under 42 United States Code section 9607(a). Some courts have required no more than a confirmation that the trust assets include contaminated property to impose liability. Other courts have sought more significant indicia of ownership, such as control of the contaminated property. A review of trustee cases reveals that trustee liability under CERCLA appears to be expanding.” Packer at 17-18, followed by analysis of cases arising from trustee status and on indicia of ownership. d. In September 1996 Congress limited a trustee’s personal liability under CERCLA by enacting the Asset Conservation, Lender Liability, and Deposit Insurance Protection Act of 1996, §§ 2501-2505 of the Omnibus Consolidated Appropriations Act, Pub L 104-208, 110 Stat 3009. (1) Under current law, a trustee’s personal liability under CERCLA is limited to the value of the assets in the trust estate. (2) A trustee may still be personally liable under CERCLA to the extent that the trustee’s own negligence caused a release of a hazardous substance. Environmental case law highlights the difficulty of identifying the scope of the trustee’s liability caused by his own negligence. See discussion in Matter of Bell Petroleum Services, Inc., 3 F 3d 889 (5th Cir 1993). (3) The new negligence standard fails to clarify the extent to which a trustee must investigate, discover, and remediate suspected contamination of trust property to be relieved from personal liability. Under 42 United States Code section 9607(n)(4), there are safe harbors which will protect the fiduciary from personal liability: (a) Undertaking or directing another person to undertake a cleanup. (b) Responding to an agency enforcement order. (c) Terminating the fiduciary relationship. d) Incorporating special environmental provisions (including indemnification of the fiduciary) into the trust agreement. (e) Inspecting the trust property. (f) Providing financial or other advice to the trust grantor or beneficiaries. (g) Administering trust property which was contaminated before the fiduciary relationship began. (h) Declining to take any action listed in 42 United States Code section 9607(n)(4). 3. UPC section 7-306(b) significantly limits the trustee’s liability arising from ownership of property: “A trustee is personally liable for obligations arising from ownership of property of the trust estate…in the course of administration of the trust estate only if he is personally at fault.” 28 ACTEC Journal 117 (2002) X. LIABILITY OF THE TRUSTEE TO BENEFICIARIES A. Breach of trust. A trustee is liable to beneficiaries for any loss to the trust estate resulting from a breach of trust committed by the trustee. Scott § 201. 1. A breach of trust is a violation by the trustee of any duty which as trustee he owes to the beneficiary. Restatement § 201. a. A breach of trust normally results if the trustee intentionally or negligently does what he ought not to do or fails to do what he ought to do. Id, Comment a. “In the world of trusts, an intentional breach is usually two breaches: a breach of the duty of loyalty coupled with some other breach…. The breach of the duty of loyalty never travels alone…. Like the intentional breach, the negligent breach is actually two or more breaches: a breach of the duty to be generally prudent in conducting the affairs of the trust couple with some other breach.” Rounds, Charles E., Jr., Loring A Trustee’s Handbook (1999 ed, Panel Publishers) §§ 7.2.1 and 7.2.2 at 215. b. However, if a trustee acts under a mistake of law or fact, a breach of trust can occur even where the trustee is not personally at fault. Id. (1) A trustee commits a breach of trust where he violates a duty resulting from his mistake regarding the extent of his duties and powers. Id., Comment b. (a) Neither the trustee’s good faith nor advice of counsel is a defense. Id. (b) Liability regarding the extent of the trustee’s duties and powers is avoided by submitting the matter to the advisory jurisdiction of the court. Scott § 201 at 221. (2) A breach of trust can also be committed as a result of mistake of fact or law concerning the exercise of the trustee’s powers or performance of his duties. Restatement § 201, Comment c. Here, however, negligence is required to subject the trustee to liability for breach of trust. Proper care and caution in the exercise of powers or performance of duties avoid liability. Id. B. Nonliability for loss in the absence of a breach of trust. 1. THE TRUSTEE IS NOT LIABLE TO THE BENEFICIARY FOR A LOSS OR DEPRECIATION IN VALUE OF THE TRUST PROPERTY, OR FOR A FAILURE TO MAKE A PROFIT, NOT RESULTING FROM A BREACH OF TRUST. Restatement § 204. 2. “A trustee is not a guarantor of the value of the trust property. He is not liable unless he has violated some duty owed by him to the beneficiaries. If a loss to the trust estate is not due to his failure to exercise reasonable care and skill to preserve the trust property or to some other breach of trust, he is not subject to a surcharge.” Scott § 204 at 234. 28 ACTEC Journal 118 (2002) a. This rule applies in the case of the trustee’s investment in property which depreciates in value, if the trustee did not commit a breach of trust in making or in continuing to hold the investment. Id. b. It also applies to the trustee’s failure to make a profit. Scott § 205. C. Trustee’s liability in case of breach of trust. 1. A trustee who commits a breach of trust is: a. [A]CCOUNTABLE FOR ANY PROFIT ACCRUING TO THE TRUST THROUGH THE BREACH OF TRUST; OR b. [C] HARGEABLE WITH THE AMOUNT REQUIRED TO RESTORE THE VALUES OF THE TRUST ESTATE AND TRUST DISTRIBUTIONS TO WHAT THEY WOULD HAVE BEEN IF THE TRUST HAD BEEN PROPERLY ADMINISTERED. RESTATEMENT 3D § 205. 2. IN ADDITION, THE TRUSTEE IS SUBJECT TO SUCH LIABILITY AS NECESSARY TO PREVENT THE TRUSTEE FROM BENEFITTING PERSONALLY FROM THE BREACH OF TRUST (SEE § 206). Id. 3. The beneficiary’s remedies are alternative in that the beneficiary has the option of affirming the transaction or surcharging the trustee. Id., Comment a. 4. If the beneficiary is under an incapacity, the court will enforce the remedy which in its opinion is the most advantageous to the beneficiary and most likely to accomplish the purposes of the trust. Restatement 3d § 205, Comment b. 5. This rule applies to trust income as well as to principal. “Thus, if the trustee in breach of trust fails to make the trust property productive he is liable for the amount of income which he would have received if he had not committed the breach of trust (see § 207).” Restatement 3d § 205, Comment i. XI. SPECIAL AREAS OF CONCERN A. Successor trustee. 1. The general rule is that a successor trustee is not liable for a breach of trust committed by a predecessor trustee. Restatement § 223. 2. However, a successor is liable for a predecessor’s breach of trust if he: a. [K]NOWS OR SHOULD KNOW OF A SITUATION CONSTITUTING A BREACH OF TRUST COMMITTED BY HIS PREDECESSOR AND HE IMPROPERLY PERMITS IT TO CONTINUE; OR b. [N]EGLECTS TO TAKE PROPER STEPS TO COMPEL THE PREDECESSOR TO DELIVER THE TRUST PROPERTY TO HIM; OR c. [N]EGLECTS TO TAKE PROPER STEPS TO REDRESS A BREACH OF TRUST COMMITTED BY THE PREDECESSOR. Id. 3. A successor trustee must take proper steps to compel the predecessor to redress a breach of trust (Continued on page 119) Calendar of Events 2002 Regional and State Meetings FridaySaturday September 13-14 FridaySunday September 13-15 Florida Fellows Meeting Place: Hyatt Regency Orlando, Florida Guest: Carlyn S. McCaffrey ACTEC President Western Regional Meeting Place: Hilton La Jolla Torrey Pines La Jolla, California Guest: Robert J. Durham, Jr. ACTEC Immediate Past President FridaySunday September 13-15 Mid-Atlantic Regional Meeting Place: Atlantic Sands Hotel Rehoboth Beach, Delaware Guest: Ronald D. Aucutt ACTEC President-Elect FridaySunday September 13-15 Quad State Regional Meeting Place: Sheraton Suites on the Plaza Kansas City, Missouri Guest: Robert J. Rosepink ACTEC Vice President Wednesday September 25 Hawaii Fellows Meeting Place: Plaza Club Honolulu, Hawaii ThursdaySunday November 7-10 Southeast Regional Meeting Place: The Inn at Harbour Town Hilton Head, South Carolina Guest: Carlyn S. McCaffrey ACTEC President FridaySunday November 8-10 Ohio ACTEC Fellows Meeting Place: Hyatt Hotel Cleveland, Ohio Guest: Judith W. McCue ACTEC Treasurer Wednesday November 25 Hawaii Fellows Meeting Place: Plaza Club Honolulu, Hawaii Wednesday December 4 Iowa Fellows Annual Luncheon Place: Des Moines Club Des Moines, Iowa Guest: Carlyn S. McCaffrey ACTEC President Friday December 13 New Orleans Fellows Dinner Place: Antoine’s New Orleans, Louisiana In Memoriam C. Henry Glovsky Beverly, Massachusetts Mannes F. Greenberg Baltimore, Maryland Any gift to the ACTEC Foundation made in the memory of a deceased Fellow will be acknowledged to the family. 28 ACTEC Journal C1 (2002) 2003 Annual Meeting Dates: Tuesday, March 4 through Monday, March 10 Place: El Conquistador Resort and Country Club Las Croabas, Puerto Rico Tuesday March 4 Committee meetings— as scheduled in the afternoon Friday March 7 Committee meetings— as scheduled in the afternoon Evening Open evening Saturday March 8 Seminars, symposium, computer workshops, athletic events and tours Dinner for 2002-2003 committee members and their spouses/guests Wednesday March 5 Evening Thursday March 6 President’s Welcome Reception For registered Fellows and registered spouses/guests Committee meetings— as scheduled in the afternoon 28 Cocktail Reception and Dinner Dance Sunday March 9 Seminars, Hot Topics, athletic events and tours Afternoon State Chairs Meeting Evening Dinner for 2002-2003 Regents, State Chairs and Past Presidents and their spouses/guests Monday March 10 Board of Regents Meeting Opening Breakfast and Annual Business Meeting Seminars, symposium, athletic events and tours Evening Committee meetings— as scheduled in the afternoon Committee meetings— as scheduled throughout the day Athletic events and tours Theme Party ACTEC Journal C2 (2002) Seminars, Trachtman Lecture, computer workshops, athletic events and tours 2003 Summer Meeting The 2003 Summer Meeting will be held in Saint Paul, Minnesota’s capital city. With its beautiful natural setting along the Mississippi River, Saint Paul is a charming, historic river city with interesting architecture, world-class theaters, museums, river cruises and award-winning dining. Saint Paul is truly a big city with small town charm. The quaint neighborhoods and family values are its cornerstone. Art, museums and many historical landmarks make Saint Paul a cultural hot spot. It was home to F. Scott Fitzgerald, Charles M. Schulz and John Dillinger. John Dillinger? That’s right, John Dillinger made Saint Paul his home when things were too hot in Chicago. This is just one of Dates: Thursday, June 26 through Sunday, June 29 Place: Radisson Riverfront Hotel St. Paul and The Saint Paul Hotel St. Paul, Minnesota Wednesday June 25 Thursday June 26 the fascinating facts you will learn about Minnesota’s capital city. Minneapolis/Saint Paul International Airport is just 81 ⁄2 miles from downtown Saint Paul, a 15-minute taxi or shuttle ride. The airport is served by nine commercial airlines which offer service from any part of the 48 contiguous states in less than four hours and less than 11 ⁄2 hours from anywhere in the Midwest. Major highways (Interstates 94 and 35E) run through downtown Saint Paul, also making it easily accessible by car from all parts of the country. Further information regarding hotel reservations and our unique tours in the Twin Cities area will be sent to you in December. Historic St. Paul Homes— Tour the James J. Hill House and the Alexander Ramsey House. Historic Houses of Worship—Visit St. Paul Cathedral and other religious institutions of architectural acclaim along Summit Avenue. Minnesota Zephyr Dinner Train— Journey back in time to the era of the late 1940s President’s Welcome Reception For all Fellows and spouses/guests— as scheduled in the evening Historic Landmark Center Committee meetings— as scheduled in the afternoon Tours: Stillwater: Birthplace of Minnesota— Find the warmth of the past in this enchanting river town on the St. Croix. Committee meetings— as scheduled throughout the day Saturday June 28 Tours: Gangster Tour—See where Dillinger, Baby Face Nelson and other Prohibition gangsters cooled off. Twin Cities Highlights Tour— Experience Twin Cities diversity; with contemporary skylines, pastoral settings, sparkling lakes and waterways. Taylor’s Fall Canoeing—A relaxing afternoon on the St. Croix River Mississippi River Dinner Cruise— Relive the Great Steamboat Era while enjoying sites along the river. Friday June 27 Private Summit Avenue House Tour— Discover Saint Paul’s historic European charm. Morning: Professional Program— to be announced Committee meetings— as scheduled throughout the day Cocktail Reception and Dinner For all Fellows and spouses/guests— Committee meetings— as scheduled in the morning Sunday June 29 Tours: Cooking Demonstration/Garden Tour— A demonstration at Cooks on Crocus Hill followed by a wonderful private garden tour. 28 ACTEC Journal C3 (2002) ACTEC National Meeting Schedule ANNUAL SUMMER FALL 2002 Wednesday–Monday February 27–March 4 La Quinta Resort & Club La Quinta, California (February 25*) Thursday–Sunday June 27–30 The Waldorf-Astoria New York, New York Wednesday–Monday October 9–14 Westin La Paloma Tucson, Arizona 2003 Wednesday–Monday March 5–10 El Conquistador Resort and Country Club Las Croabas, Puerto Rico (March 3*) Thursday–Sunday June 26–29 Radisson Riverfront Hotel/ The Saint Paul Hotel St. Paul, Minnesota Wednesday–Monday October 29–November 3 Charleston Place/ The Mills House Charleston, South Carolina 2004 Wednesday–Monday March 10–15 Westin La Cantera San Antonio, Texas (March 8*) Thursday–Sunday July 8–11 Fairmont Empress/ Hotel Grand Pacific Victoria, B.C., Canada Wednesday–Monday October 20–25 Omni William Penn Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania 2005 Wednesday–Monday February 23–28 Hyatt Regency Grand Cypress Hotel Orlando, Florida (February 21*) Thursday–Sunday June 23–26 The Westin Hotel Michigan Avenue Chicago, Illinois Wednesday–Monday October 19–24 Amelia Island Plantation Amelia Island, Florida 2006 Wednesday–Monday March 8–13 Grand Wailea Resort Maui, Hawaii (March 6*) Thursday–Saturday July 6–9 Millennium Biltmore Hotel Los Angeles, California Wednesday–Monday October 11-16 Providence, Rhode Island 2007 Wednesday–Monday March 7–12 The Westin Kierland Resort & Spa Scottsdale, Arizona To be determined To be determined 2008 Wednesday–Monday March 5–10 Boca Raton Resort and Club Boca Raton, Florida (March 3*) To be determined To be determined 2009 Wednesday–Monday March 4–9 The Westin Mission Hills Resort Rancho Mirage, California (March 2*) To be determined To be determined * Committee members early arrival 28 ACTEC Journal C4 (2002) (Continued from page 118) committed by the predecessor, and the successor is liable to the extent to which a loss results from his failure to take such steps. Id., Comment d. 4. “A successor trustee is liable for breach of trust if he neglects to take proper steps to compel the sureties on his predecessor’s bond to indemnify the trust estate for liabilities incurred through a breach of trust committed by his predecessor.” Scott § 223.3 at 401. B. Breach of trust by co-trustee. 1. The general rule is that a trustee is not liable to the beneficiary for a breach of trust committed by a co-trustee. Restatement § 224. 2. However, there are several exceptions. A trustee will be liable for acts of his co- trustee, if he: a. [P]ARTICIPATES IN A BREACH OF TRUST COMMITTED BY HIS CO-TRUSTEE; OR b. [I]MPROPERLY DELEGATES THE ADMINISTRATION OF THE TRUST TO HIS CO- TRUSTEE; OR c. [A]PPROVES OR ACQUIESCES IN OR CONCEALS A BREACH OF TRUST COMMITTED BY HIS CO TRUSTEE; OR d. [B]Y HIS FAILURE TO EXERCISE REASONABLE CARE IN THE ADMINISTRATION OF THE TRUST HAS ENABLED HIS CO - TRUSTEE TO COMMIT A BREACH OF TRUST; OR e. [N]EGLECTS TO TAKE PROPER STEPS TO COMPEL HIS CO - TRUSTEE TO REDRESS A BREACH OF TRUST. Id. 3. Where several trustees are liable for a joint breach of trust or for a breach of trust by a co-trustee under the rules described above, their liability to the beneficiary is joint and several. Id., Comment a. C. Acts of agents. See generally Bennett, Charles M., “When the Fiduciary’s Agent Errs–Who Pays the Bill–Fiduciary, Agent, or Beneficiary?” 28 Real Prop Prob and Trust LJ 429 (1993). 1. With certain exceptions, the trustee is not liable to the beneficiary for acts of the trustee’s agents employed in the administration of the trust. Restatement § 225(1). 2. Those exceptions involve an agent’s act, which if done by the trustee would constitute a breach of trust, if the trustee: a. [D]IRECTS OR PERMITS THE ACT OF THE AGENT; OR b. [D]ELEGATES TO THE AGENT THE PERFORMANCE OF ACTS WHICH HE WAS UNDER A DUTY NOT TO DELEGATE; OR c. [D]OES NOT USE REASONABLE CARE IN THE SELECTION OR RETENTION OF THE AGENT; OR d. [D]OES NOT EXERCISE PROPER SUPERVISION OVER THE CONDUCT OF THE AGENT; OR e. [A]PPROVES OR ACQUIESCES IN OR CON- CEALS THE ACT OF THE AGENT; OR f. [N]EGLECTS TO TAKE PROPER STEPS TO COMPEL THE AGENT TO REDRESS THE WRONG. Restate- ment § 225(2)(a)-(f). 3. Accordingly, under appropriate circumstances, a trustee may not be liable for acts of his agent. See Russell v. Rici, 213 N E 2d 566 (Ill 1966) (trustee blameless for loss on conversion of sales proceeds where he properly delegated authority to attorney to exchange deed upon payment of purchase price). 4. However, an error of the agent may constitute a breach of trust by the trustee. See Estate of Lohm, 269 A 2d 451 (Pa 1970) (co-executors guilty of negligence where untimely filed estate tax return resulted in loss to estate; reliance on properly retained counsel does not excuse failure to ascertain crucial filing dates, as trustees should have known that tax returns were due). Presumably there would have been no trustee liability if the return had been filed on a timely basis but asserted positions that resulted in penalties to the estate, as the co-executors would not have been expected to know that the positions were wrong. 5. Restatement § 225(2) limits liability to acts of agents “which if done by the trustee would constitute a breach of trust.” Given this language, is a trustee liable if he improperly delegates to an agent who acts reasonably but nevertheless causes a loss? It seems strange the Restatement would approve improper delegation so long as the agent acts reasonably. Comment a further confuses the issue and implies that a trustee is always liable for improper delegation: “[A trustee] is not liable to the beneficiary for losses resulting from the improper conduct of the agent, unless the trustee is himself guilty of a breach of trust. The trustee is himself guilty of a breach of trust under the circumstances stated in Subsection (2) and is liable therefor.” Thus, any of the actions or inactions listed above is itself a breach of trust for which the trustee is liable. 6. A corporate trustee is liable to the beneficiary for acts or omissions of its own officers and employees committed in the course of their employment. However, they are not considered agents in the administration of the trust for purposes of this rule. Restatement § 225, Comment b. D. Payments or conveyances made to persons other than the beneficiary. 1. IF BY THE TERMS OF THE TRUST IT IS THE DUTY OF THE TRUSTEE TO PAY OR CONVEY THE TRUST PROPERTY OR ANY PART THEREOF TO A BENEFICIARY, HE IS LIABLE IF HE PAYS OR CONVEYS TO A PERSON WHO IS NEITHER THE BENEFICIARY NOR ONE TO WHOM THE BENEFICIARY OR THE COURT HAS AUTHORIZED HIM TO MAKE SUCH PAYMENT OR CONVEYANCE. Restatement § 226. 2. This rule applies to trust income as well as to trust principal. It also applies whether the payment 28 ACTEC Journal 119 (2002) or conveyance is made at or before termination of the trust. Id, Comment a. 3. Reasonable mistake of fact or law does not absolve the trustee. Restatement § 226, Comment b. 4. If a creditor of a beneficiary has acquired a 28 ACTEC Journal 120 (2002) legitimate lien on the beneficiary’s interest and the trustee has notice of the lien, the trustee is liable to the creditor if he pays or conveys income or property to the beneficiary. Restatement § 226, Comment e. However, this is an area governed by statute in many states. Total Return Unitrusts: Is This a Solution in Search of a Problem? by Alvin J. Golden* Austin, Texas TABLE OF CONTENTS I. INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .122 II. PURPOSE AND SCOPE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123 III. THE ROLE OF THE ESTATE PLANNER 123 A. Qualities to Be Possessed by the Draftsman . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .123 B. Determine the Needs of the Client . . . . .124 C. Determine How Those Needs Can Best Be Accomplished . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124 D. Assist the Client in Choosing a Trustee 124 IV. SOME INTRODUCTORY MATTERS . . .124 A. Definition of Private Unitrust . . . . . . . .124 B. A Brief History . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .124 1. Prudent Man Theory . . . . . . . . . . . . .124 2. Prudent Investor Rule . . . . . . . . . . . . .125 C. Modern Portfolio Theory . . . . . . . . . . . .125 1. The General Rule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .125 2. Diversification and Risks . . . . . . . . . .125 3. The Efficient Capital Market Hypothesis (ECMH) . . . . . . . . . . . . .126 V. THE ARGUMENTS FOR AND AGAINST THE USE OF UNITRUSTS . . . . . . . . . . . .127 A. Some of the Principal Players . . . . . . . .127 B. The Arguments for the Unitrust . . . . . .127 1. The Unfairness of the “All Income” Requirement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .127 2. Simplifies Investment Decision Making and Distributions . . . . . . . . . .127 3. Elimination of Friction . . . . . . . . . . . .128 C. The Arguments Against the Routine Use of Unitrusts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128 1. Inflexibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128 2. Discretion Is Usually Given Even in a Unitrust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .128 3. Protection of the Trustee . . . . . . . . . .128 4. Assumes a Financial Portfolio . . . . . .129 5. Difficulty of Administration . . . . . . . .129 *Copyright 2002. Alvin J. Golden. All rights reserved. Appendices to this article are posted on the ACTEC Web site at www.actec.org/Documents/misc/UniProbGoldenAppendices.pdf. VI. SOME BASIC FALLACIES IN THE RUSH TO FIXED RETURN UNITRUSTS . . . . . .129 A. The Theory is Untested . . . . . . . . . . . . .129 B. Trusts That Are Invested the Same Way Produce the Same Result . . . . . . . .129 C. Ignores Human Nature . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130 D. Bull Markets Make the Unitrust Hum. . .130 VII. THE ECONOMICS OF THE UNITRUST 130 A. Types of Trusts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130 1. Unitrusts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130 2. Fixed Payout Trusts Not Tied to Value or Market Averages . . . . . . . . .130 3. Trusts with a Discretionary Distribution Standard . . . . . . . . . . . . .130 4. Fixed Payout Based on Market Averages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .130 5. The “Give-Me-Five” Trust . . . . . . . . .131 B. Economic Considerations . . . . . . . . . . .131 1. History as a Predictor . . . . . . . . . . . . .131 2. Use of Averages in Projections . . . . .131 3. Volatility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .132 4. Inability to Protect the Real Value . . .133 5. “Excess” Distributions of Bond Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133 6. A Summary of the Effects of the Various Policies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .133 VIII. ACCOMPLISHMENT OF CLIENT’S OBJECTIVE AND SOME SURPRISING THINGS YOU MAY NOT HAVE THOUGHT ABOUT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134 A. Focus Should Be on the “Real” Beneficiary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134 1. Understanding the Difference Between Distributions, Spending and Return . . .134 2. Understanding Whether the Client’s Desires Can Be Met . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134 3. Real Returns . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135 4. Costs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135 B. The One Thing the Beneficiary of a 4% Unitrust Never Gets Is 4% . . . . . . .135 1. Effect of Smoothing . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135 2. Effect of Tax Allocation. . . . . . . . . . .135 IX. LEGISLATIVE APPROACHES IN GENERAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .135 28 ACTEC Journal 121 (2002) X. UPAIA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136 A. The Power to Reallocate . . . . . . . . . . . . .136 1. Trustee’s Power to Reallocate — UPAIA §104 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136 2. Exception to Trustee’s Power to Reallocate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .136 3. Application to Existing Trusts . . . . . .136 4. Judicial Control of Discretionary Powers — New UPAIA §105 . . . . . . .137 5. Will Trustees Exercise This Discretion? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137 6. How Will the Trustee Exercise This Discretion? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .137 XI. STATE OPT-IN STATUTES . . . . . . . . . . . .138 A. New York’s Initial Attempt . . . . . . . . . .138 B. The Variations Among States . . . . . . . . .138 C. Considerations Prior to Converting . . .138 1. Desire of the Beneficiaries . . . . . . . . .138 2. Availability of UPAIA §104 . . . . . . . .138 3. Composition of the Trust . . . . . . . . . .138 4. Projections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138 XII. THE IRS RESPONSE TO MODERN PORTFOLIO THEORY AND THE “ALL INCOME” TRUST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .138 A. Amendment to Definition of Income . . .139 B. Capital Gains Allocated to DNI and Capital Losses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139 C. Distributions in Kind . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .139 D. Charitable Remainder Unitrust . . . . . .139 E. Marital Deduction Provisions . . . . . . . .140 F. GST Regulations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140 G. Qualified Domestic Trust . . . . . . . . . . . .140 XIII. NON-UNITRUST ALTERNATIVES TO DEALING WITH ALL INCOME FORMULATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .140 A. Solutions to the Statutorily Mandated All Income Trusts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141 1. Discretionary Principal Distribution .141 2. Formula Distributions . . . . . . . . . . . .141 3. Redefine Income . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .141 4. Powers of Appointment . . . . . . . . . . .142 B. Conventional Solutions Where All Income Is Not Mandated . . . . . . . . . . . .142 1. Total Discretion Trusts . . . . . . . . . . . .142 2. Distributions According to Standard . . .142 3. Formula Distributions . . . . . . . . . . . .142 4. Powers of Appointment . . . . . . . . . . .142 C. The Give-Me-Five Approach . . . . . . . . .142 1. Underlying Theories . . . . . . . . . . . . .143 2. Use with All Income Trusts, et. al. . . .143 3. Use as Marital Trust. . . . . . . . . . . . . .143 4. Flexibility and Easing of Tensions . . .143 28 ACTEC Journal 122 (2002) 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. A Sample Clause . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143 Creditor Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .143 Transfer Tax Avoidance . . . . . . . . . . .144 Income Tax and Grantor Trust Issues . .144 Assumes Financial Corpus . . . . . . . . .144 XIV. SOME UNITRUST PROVISIONS . . . . . .144 A. Hoisington Provisions (as Modified by Golden) . . . . . . . . . . . . .144 1. Discretionary Distributions Not to Exceed Certain Percentage of Value . .144 2. Discretionary Distributions Not to Exceed Fixed (Inflation Adjusted) Amount . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .145 3. The Fixed Percent of Market Value . .146 4. Indexed Annuity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .147 5. Market Performance Unitrust . . . . . . .147 B. The Northern Trust Forms . . . . . . . . . .148 XV. CONCLUSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148 A. The Economic Conclusions . . . . . . . . . .148 B. Fixing Existing Trusts . . . . . . . . . . . . . .148 C. The Drafting Conclusions . . . . . . . . . . .148 D. The Bottom Line . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .149 APPENDICES........www.actec.org/Documents/misc/ UniProbGoldenAppendices.pdf I. INTRODUCTION In conceptualizing the structure of a trust, draftsmen have pictured an income interest followed by a remainder interest, even though the income recipient and the remainderman may be one and the same. Thus, traditional trust drafting has long concentrated on the distinction between income and principal, and has often set different standards for the disbursement of each. This traditional approach has been adopted in the tax laws also.1 Subchapter J relies in many instances on the concept of trust accounting income. The QTIP rules mandate that the spouse has a right to receive all the income and the QSST rules likewise require the distribution of all income. State statutes also rely on the distinction between income and principal; e.g., the rules in the Texas Trust Code for trust accounting and the “prudent man” standard. Equally as important, trustees traditionally have made investment decisions to produce a certain level of income. However, in this brave new world of modern portfolio theory, the investment gurus preach overall return without regard to such time-honored distinctions. This approach is indeed adopted in Restatement of the Law of Trusts, Third, and the Uniform Prudent Investor Act (“UPIA”). However, the tax laws are adapting to the need for investing for overall return as reflected in the proposed regulations under §643(b). 1 II. PURPOSE AND SCOPE Most of the literature dealing with private unitrusts is written by persons with a definite point of view, and, while sometimes attempting to be somewhat evenhanded, they still advocate the particular author’s viewpoint. While this paper (which is now in its sixth iteration and still developing) started out to present a bipartisan approach, I would be less than honest if I did not admit up front that I have, as my thinking evolved, developed a definite viewpoint. Thus, this paper takes the position that the fixed return unitrust should not be the default drafting method for dealing with the sufficiency of distributions to the income beneficiary. More importantly, however, is the feeling (expressed throughout the paper) that the real solution is for the draftsman to spend more time talking to the client in depth about what the client is trying to accomplish with the trust, and then draft to accomplish that goal. Hopefully, then, this discussion will also cause practitioners to rethink the manner in which trusts are drafted and to encourage draftsmen to cause the client to focus more sharply on the client’s desires rather than lapsing into the automatic formulations—all income and HEMS principal, total trustee discretion as to either income, principal or both, unitrusts or annuity trusts.2 Particularly in these times following the passage of EGTRRA in which the possibility of repeal of the estate tax looms, it becomes even more important that documents reflect the desires of the testator or grantor as well as tax considerations. This outline will examine some of the various options available for the design of private (as opposed to charitable) unitrusts, as well as the considerations of reconciling traditional trust concepts with modern portfolio theory. It will delve briefly into modern portfolio theory, prudent investor standards, and some comments on the 1997 Uniform Principal and Income Act (“UPAIA”). It will also discuss the new proposed regulations under Internal Revenue Code §643(b) as they impact the availability of unitrusts and the application of UPAIA §104. The broader question which this paper will attempt to Professor Dobris at the University of California Davis Law School has noted the same necessity: In the past, the garden variety trustee of an “income to A remainder to B” trust would create a conservative portfolio, enabling him to pay the traditional income to A and when A died, pay the remainder to B. The more conscientious trustee might try to come to an understanding of what the settlor intended and what the income beneficiary wanted, and structure the investments accordingly. Modern Portfolio Theory notwithstanding, trustees will likely continue to operate in the way described. There will be, however, more pressure on lawyers to discuss with the clients the clients’ ideas about what kind of income stream the trust is expect2 answer is, “Is the unitrust an answer to the problem in the current investment environment, or is it merely a solution in search of a problem to solve?” III. THE ROLE OF THE ESTATE PLANNER In the immediately following portions of the paper, modern portfolio theory and its underlying economic theory will be discussed. The rationale behind the growth of unitrusts will also be explored and critically analyzed. What, you may legitimately ask, is the relevance to me as an estate planner to develop an understanding of the basics of underlying financial theory and the arguments for and against unitrusts? “Why should I care about efficient markets when I do not advise clients about their investments?” The answer could be that we should all thirst for knowledge, but it really is not. The answer is that, as competition increases from financial planners, CPAs and other professionals (and some not so professional), the focus of the attorney must change and increased skills must be brought to bear. And, if you are to use unitrusts in drafting, you should understand some of the effects that are not readily apparent when reading articles by the advocates of that technique. A. Qualities to be Possessed by the Draftsman In his Heckerling Institute article,3 William Hoisington, a California lawyer who was one of the first and is still a leading advocate for fixed return unitrusts, lists five skills the estate planner must have to develop a successful distribution formula: (1) a reasonably clear understanding of the settlor’s human and financial objectives for the trust, (2) a reasonably clear understanding of the personal circumstances and financial needs of the trust beneficiaries (present and future), (3) some understanding of modern financial principals and the supporting empirical data, (4) a reasonably clear understanding of the investment strategies that are likely to be employed by the trustee and of the probable financial consequences of each of those strategies, and ed to provide for the life tenant and what kind of value is to go to the remainder beneficiary. To the extent that lawyers currently steer clear of discussions of investment return and the financial role of the trust in the beneficiaries’ lives, that is likely to change over the next decades. (Emphasis added) Dobris, Changes of the Role and the Form of the Trust in the New Millennium, Or, We Don’t Have to Think of England Anymore, 62 Albany L.R. 543 (1998), at 570, fn. 125. 3 Hoisington. “Modern Trust Design: New Paradigms for the 21st Century,” 31st University of Miami Heckerling Institute on Estate Planning ¶603 (1997) 28 ACTEC Journal 123 (2002) (5) expert level knowledge of the alternative distribution designs and constituent distribution formulas that may be used to implement the settlor’s human and financial objectives for the trust. B. Determine the Needs of the Client For too many years, the focus of estate planning attorneys has been more on complying with tax statutes and less on really analyzing what the client is trying to accomplish with the trust. In some cases, such as a QTIP trust with the surviving spouse as trustee, the desire of the client is easily manifest. It is not so easy in a second marriage situation with a nonspousal trustee, especially if the trustee is a child by the first marriage. It is also not so easy to determine the desires of the client when the beneficiary is a child or other descendant. Many clients today worry that their children will have no incentive to be productive citizens if they can rely on the trust, and those clients desire that the trust be designed to avoid that result to the extent possible, while still providing some benefits. C. Determine How Those Needs Can Best Be Accomplished If the estate planner is truly to meet the needs of the client as far as payouts (distributions) from the trust, the attorney must understand the economics which will be necessary to produce those returns, and the economic effects of the approach employed, whether it be discretionary, ascertainable standard, unitrust, annuity trust, etc. Does this mean that the attorney should also take on the role of the investment advisor? ABSOLUTELY NOT! It has long been accepted that the attorney must understand the various insurance products and the different purposes each serves without any thought that he was replacing the life underwriter. The same is true of the relationship with the financial planner or investment advisor. D. Assist the Client in Choosing a Trustee A critical choice in this process is the choice of the Trustee. There are many factors involved in deciding whether to choose a family member, a close friend (almost never a good idea) or an institution, or some sort of co-trustee arrangements. The choice of trustee will affect, or in many cases dictate, the distribution formula and the availability of UPAIA §104. Removal and replacement powers are also of utmost importance. 4 When used generically, “unitrust” also includes an annuity trust. It could be argued that a mandatory income trust which allows distributions of principal based upon a health, education, maintenance and support standard is a unitrust in that the beneficiary is provided for irrespective of the income of the trust. However, the fact that the beneficiary has a right to all the income (and, conversely, that all the income MUST be distributed), argues 5 28 ACTEC Journal 124 (2002) No third party trustee should ever be appointed that someone does not have the right to remove. IV. SOME INTRODUCTORY MATTERS A. Definition of Private Unitrust The inclination is to think of private unitrusts in the same terms as charitable unitrusts; i.e., a trust with a fixed return to the current beneficiary.4 However, for purposes of this paper, a private unitrust is any trust other than a trust which draws a distinction between income and principal in establishing a distribution standard. The most common trust which is not a unitrust is a mandatory income distribution trust with or without any power to invade principal.5 As discussed below, unitrusts can be used as a primary distribution formula, or to supplement all income trusts. Unitrusts can be as simple as a pure discretionary trust, or as complex as a trust in which the distributions are dependent upon market performance by tying distributions to earnings, such as a percentage of the average dividends paid by companies listed on the Standard & Poor’s 500 Index. In actuality, the use of §104 of UPAIA converts a standard all income trust to a unitrust, but not necessarily one in which the return is determined by a fixed percentage which cannot vary from year to year. B. A Brief History 1. Prudent Man6 Theory The development of the all-income standard probably descends from an agrarian society in which wealth was the land and, after putting back funds needed for next year’s crop (plus perhaps a reserve against weather and other natural disasters), the remaining money could be spent without diminution of capital. In line with that, one of the leading aphorisms in regard to investing, “spend income but protect principal,” was embodied in the prudent man rule adopted by Restatement of the Law of Trusts, Second, in §227, which mandated a trustee: to make such investments and only such investments as a prudent man would make of his own property having in view the preservation of the estate and the amount and the regularity of the income derived therefrom. [Emphasis added.]7 against this kind of trust being treated as a unitrust. 6 With apologies for not being politically correct (i.e., referring to the rule as the “Prudent Person Rule),” I simply use the term utilized in the statutes and Restatement. 7 It might be possible to argue that preservation of capital includes protecting it from inflation, but it is doubtful that was the meaning contemplated by the Restatement. The Texas Prudent Man Rule, adopted in 1983 with the codification of the Texas Trust Code, §113.056(a), is a hybrid of the prudent man rule, since it commands a trustee to invest: Under the prudent investor standard, the trustee is still bound by the duties of loyalty and impar- tiality. See Restatement of the Law of Trusts, Third §227, and the comments thereunder. Restating the obvious, the prudent investor standard still holds the trustee to a duty of prudence, while redefining what constitutes prudence. C. Modern Portfolio Theory9 The driving force behind the rise of the prudent investor rule is the advent of modern portfolio theory. This aggregate of economic theories is based upon the idea that the financial markets are efficient (a term of art) and that the investor will choose investments based upon diversification and degree of acceptable risk. While these are concepts in which the estate planning attorney has not usually dealt, they are concepts which drive the debate over the use of unitrusts in estate planning. 1. The General Rule Traditional investment philosophy was that a sophisticated investor, by studying past performance and analyzing relevant data, particularly price data, could find undervalued stocks or stocks that were about to increase in value because of growth of the company, and stay ahead of the market averages. While some portfolios may have been diversified, diversification was not a central concern. But diversification is one of the centerpieces of modern portfolio theory. In addition to an emphasis on diversification, modern portfolio theory posits that the market is “efficient,” and to an extent a “random walk” (both theories discussed below), and thus the successful investor does not get that way by picking and choosing individual issues, but rather by diversification, reduction of risk, and reduction of volatility. 2. Diversification and Risks One of the guiding principles under modern portfolio theory is that investors, particularly institutional investors, are risk averse. This does not mean 8 This rule is set forth in the completely revised §227 of Restatement, Third as follows: The trustee is under a duty to the beneficiaries to invest and mange the funds of the trust as a prudent investor would, in light of the purposes, terms, distribution requirements, and other circumstances of the trust. (a) This standard requires the exercise of reasonable care, skill, and caution, and is to be applied to investments not in isolation but in the context of the trust portfolio and as a part of an overall investment strategy, which should incorporate risk and return objectives reasonably suitable to the trust. (b) In making and implementing investment decisions, the trustee has a duty to diversify the investments of the trust unless, under the circumstances, it is prudent not to do so. (c) In addition, the trustee must: (1) act with prudence in deciding whether and how to delegate authority and in the selection and supervision of agents (§171); and (2) incur only costs that are reasonable in amount and appropriate to the investment responsibilities of the trusteeship (§188). (d) The trustee’s duties under this Section are subject to the rule of §228, dealing primarily with contrary investment provisions of a trust or statute. 9 Much of the material in this section is based upon Macey, An Introduction to Modern Financial Theory, 2d Edition, published by the American College of Trust and Estate Counsel Foundation. A copy may be obtained from the Foundation at 3415 S. Sepulveda Blvd., Suite 330, Los Angeles, CA 90034. ...not in regard to speculation, but in regard to the permanent distribution of their funds, considering the probable income from, as well as the probable increase in value and the safety of their capital. [Emphasis added.] 2. Prudent Investor Rule In an increasingly service oriented and information driven society, and in an environment in which the returns (dividends) on stocks are low, along with relatively low interest rates on fixed income securities, a different philosophy has taken hold. This theory, which derives from modern portfolio theory, is known as the prudent investor rule8 and is set forth in §2(a) of the Uniform Prudent Investor Act (“UPIA”). The rule has three basic tenets as its underpinnings: 1. Trustees should invest for total return; 2. The investments must be suitable to the purposes of the trust (emphasis added); and 3. In determining whether the trustee has acted with prudence, the entire portfolio must be examined, rather than an asset by asset valuation. 28 ACTEC Journal 125 (2002) that investors do not take risks; rather that the intelligent investor determines the amount of risk the investor is willing to take, and then structures the investments in the portfolio to that level of risk. The balancing of risk and return is what determines the price an investor is willing to pay. There are basically two kinds of risks, firm specific risk and systematic risk. a. Firm Specific Risk Firm specific risk can be almost entirely eliminated with diversification, which is nothing more than following the old adage about not putting all of your eggs in one basket. Enron is a perfect example of firm specific risk; i.e., that any particular company’s value can be influenced by factors peculiar to that company. Firm specific risk theory can also be applied to industry groups. For example, if your investments are all in oil stocks, and the price of oil drops, then the value of the portfolio will drop also. But if your portfolio also contains utility stocks, which are likely to improve if the cost of fuel drops, then you have substantially reduced firm specific risk because the loss in value of part of the portfolio is offset by the rise in value of another part. Studies have shown that it does not require a great deal of diversification to almost eliminate firm specific risk. As few as ten stocks, properly diversified, will eliminate 88.5% of the firm specific risk, while twenty stocks will eliminate 94% of such risk. b. Systematic Risk Systematic risk cannot be diversified away nearly so easily. This is the type of risk which occurs because the system itself reacts to an external force; for example, an increase in interest rates by the Federal Reserve or a general economic downturn. Diversification into non-U.S. markets can, to some extent, reduce systematic risk. c. Balancing Risk and Return—The Capital Asset Pricing Model Again stating the obvious, an investor will insist upon a greater return (or the chance of a greater return) in direct proportion to the risk assumed. Macey, supra, refers to this as “incremental happiness.” For instance, a gift of $100 to you now, while appreciated, is less appreciated than a gift of $100 to you while you were student. Suppose you had $1,000,000 and someone offered to bet you $500,000 on a flip of a coin or a cut of the cards. Most people would probably not take that wager, since the loss of half your wealth is more terrifying than a 50% increase in your wealth is rewarding. However, if the wager were to double or triple your wealth on the upside, and still only lose half on the downside, the proposition becomes more attractive. That, basically, is how stocks are priced—the investor determines that the reward to be received is sufficient to risk his capital. 28 ACTEC Journal 126 (2002) d. Volatility Diversification can also be used to reduce volatility of the overall portfolio. As counterintuitive as it may seem, adding a dash of highly speculative stocks or foreign stocks to a portfolio may reduce overall volatility because those stocks may well run opposite to the domestic market as a whole. Reducing volatility is simply another way of reducing risk. 3. The Efficient Capital Market Hypothesis (ECMH) Modern portfolio theory depends upon the efficiency of the market. ECMH holds that a market is efficient if the prices of the goods sold in that market fully reflect all available information about those goods; i.e., when new information becomes available, such new information is immediately reflected in the price of goods. In these days of the Internet and rapid communication, if ECMH is correct, the markets will become even more efficient. a. Weak Form Efficiency Weak form efficiency holds that past price performance is not a predictor of future price performance. This is the “random walk” theory, which does not mean that stock prices are random, but rather means that an investor cannot make a profit by using past pricing to determine future value. As Professor Macey describes it, If you leave a drunken person in a field and you want to find him later, how should you go about looking for him? If the assumption is that the drunk will wander in a random pattern, then the best place to begin a search is where the drunk was last seen. That position will produce an unbiased estimate of the drunk’s future position. Macey, supra, at 40. In other words, ascertaining where the stock price has been is not helpful since it does not predict where it is likely to go. b. Semi-Strong Form Efficiency While weak form efficiency relies only on one form of available data (price), semi-strong form efficiency posits that the price immediately reflects all publicly available data. Thus, an analyst, using such data, cannot find “undervalued” stocks, because such data is already reflected in the price of such stock. There is strong empirical evidence that the weak form and semi-strong form efficiency are valid hypotheses. The emphasis on better accounting standards and reporting will strengthen semi-strong efficiency. c. Strong Form Efficiency. Strong form efficiency takes the ECMH to its logical conclusion. It holds that all information, both public and private, is immediately reflected in the price of the stock. If this form of efficiency were true, then even insiders could not out perform other investors. There is little empirical evidence that this form of efficiency exists, but with the increase in both amount and speed of available information, it will become increasingly difficult for someone to possess private information, and thus the markets will become more efficient. A recent SEC rule requiring public disclosure of certain data to the public at the same time it is disclosed to analysts and mutual fund managers is a move in this direction. AUTHOR’S NOTE: Does all this market efficiency mean that the professional money manager is obsolete? No. While there is little reality in the hope that a money manager will find undervalued stocks on a consistent basis, there is still a certain amount of skill and experience required to assemble the properly diversified portfolio for each individual investor. V. THE ARGUMENTS FOR AND AGAINST THE USE OF UNITRUSTS A. Some of the Principal Players Two of the principal attorneys involved in this discussion are William Hoisington, a California attorney, and Robert Wolf of Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania, both of whom are ACTEC Fellows and leading advocates for the use of private unitrusts. Jerry Horn, of Peoria Illinois, a past president of ACTEC, has also written on this matter, but, as will be discussed below, his viewpoint differs markedly from that of Messrs. Hoisington and Wolf. There are several economists and academicians involved in this debate also. Most prominent are David Levine, former chief financial analyst for Sanford Bernstein & Co., and James P. Garland, an economist with the Jeffrey Company in Ohio. It is interesting to note that Messrs. Hoisington and Wolf favor the fixed return unitrusts while the economists who have weighed in on this matter believe that such trusts present serious problems. B. The Arguments for the Unitrust Two factors combined to create the impetus to seek a nontraditional form of drafting for trust distributions—the rise of modern portfolio theory and the 10 Note that a decline in value has not produced an increase in income in relation to values in the new millennium. If the present market conditions continue for any substantial period of time, will the unitrust appear nearly as attractive? diminution of income in relation to increases in value caused by the incredible bull market of the second half of the 1990’s.10 This discussion continues on three levels—(i) the drafting of private unitrusts, (ii) legislation, in those states which have adopted UPAIA, to allow the conversion of existing trusts which use income as a distribution standard to unitrusts (but not annuity trusts) and/or allowing the trustee greater flexibility in allocating between receipts between income and principal, and (iii) the almost lemming-like rush to adopt legislation which will permit an existing “income rule” trust to be converted to a unitrust. There are, as nearly as I can discern, three principal arguments for the use of unitrusts. 1. The Unfairness of the “All Income” Requirement The tax statutes have for some time required, and still require, that all of the income be available (marital deduction trusts), or be actually distributed (QSSTs) to the beneficiary of certain kinds of trusts. This directs the Trustee, in effect, to invest the trust in such manner as to produce a reasonable return for the income beneficiary. The restriction on investments created by this approach is in direct conflict with modern portfolio theory which mandates investment for overall return. Further, in the current environment, with low dividend yields and falling interest rates, it is very difficult for the Trustee to invest in such a way as to produce a reasonable return and still maintain the real11 value of the trust. The private unitrust is thus seen as a method to assure that the current beneficiary receives a reasonable distribution. There are other, and I believe better techniques which should be considered in trying to obtain a fair distribution for the current beneficiary. 2. Simplifies Investment Decision Making and Distributions Since the trustee does not have to be concerned as to the character of the return produced, the trustee may simply look for the best investment return, and thus its decision making process is simplified because the goal is straightforward. In fact, the underlying argument here is that the trustee can take a greater position in equities because, as everyone knows, in the long run equities produce a better return than any other investment. As an additional benefit, distributions are fixed by the instrument and therefore (at least theoretically) easily determined. 11 “Real” as used herein means adjusted for inflation, while “nominal” means that no time value is taken into account and dollars are expressed in constant terms. 28 ACTEC Journal 127 (2002) 3. Elimination of Friction The unitrust approach is advocated as a “win-win” (or perhaps even “win-win-win”) approach in that it eliminates friction between the current beneficiary and the remainder beneficiary, while a trust with any real trustee discretion has the possibility (and perhaps even the probability) of creating friction every time the trustee makes a distribution or investment decision. In a unitrust environment, so the argument goes, a trustee may invest for overall return without regard to archaic distinctions between income and principal. Thus, if the trustee is successful in increasing the value of the trust, the current beneficiary gets larger distributions, the value of the remainder interest increases, and everyone lives happily ever after. And, if the value goes down, both classes of beneficiaries suffer equally, thus providing company for everyone’s misery (and a common enemy in the trustee who ought to “do better” no matter what the market). Also, the argument goes, the duty of impartiality is automatically satisfied. The annuity trust is also designed to provide a fair return to the current distributee and usually is designed to maintain the purchasing power of the distribution through indexing. While the annuity trust eliminates friction also, it does not have the same effect of a rising tide lifting all ships. Whether the value of the trust goes up or down, the annuity amount remains constant, except as it may be adjusted for changes in economic indices. Thus, if the value of the trust increases at a pace greater than the index used, the annuity distribution is a smaller portion of the trust. On the other hand, if the value of the trust decreases, the annuity distribution becomes a larger portion of the trust. In a steep, prolonged decline, this formula could seriously affect the viability of the trust. In almost any environment, an annuity trust is counter-cyclical. C. The Arguments Against the Routine Use of Unitrusts The caption for this portion was carefully chosen. As noted earlier, unitrusts and annuity trusts are not malum in se. Rather, they are an arrow in the estate planner’s quiver to be used in those situations in which they meet the testator or grantor’s carefully considered goals, but only in those situations. However, they should not be used routinely as the preferred default technique for the following reasons. 1. Inflexibility It is axiomatic that the best planning is the most flexible planning, allowing the trustee to adjust its actions (both as to investments and distributions) to fit the situations that changing times present so that the purposes of the trust may be carried out. The primary problem with the unitrust and annuity trust approach is the total lack of flexibility offered by such trusts. At least in the income-principal formulation, the trustee can affect the returns to the current beneficiary through investment choices. In the unitrust scenario, the trustee is mandated to pay a fixed percentage of the value of the trust to the current beneficiary; and the annuity trust mandates a fixed dollar amount without regard to the value of the trust. Ten years ago, it would have been impossible to have anticipated the state of the investment markets in the last half of the 1990s, although the decline in this millennium may have been more predictable (except as to timing). How can we advise our clients to establish long term trusts which are inflexible? In fact, it is this inflexibility that could well negate the proposed benefit of easing friction among classes of beneficiaries: Although commentary implies that a total return trust design coupled with a unitrust or indexed annuity distribution formula mitigates the potential for conflict between current and remainder beneficiaries, such a result may not actually occur. Grantor selection and trustee implementation of irrevocable distribution formulae may create a level of antagonism between beneficiary classes equal to that found in the more traditional net income trusts. The antagonism arises not so much from the operation of the formula, but from its initial selection and the ensuing consequences.12 2. Discretion Is Usually Given Even in a Unitrust To counter the inflexibility argument, leading proponents of the use of unitrusts also advocate that the unitrust be given some flexibility by giving the trustee discretion to make distributions in addition to the unitrust amount. The mere presence of this discretion, in many cases, will create the same friction as an “all income” trust with principal invasion powers. 3. Protection of the Trustee This is a corollary to the lack of flexibility. One “virtue” of the unitrust, as noted above, is it puts all beneficiaries and the trustee on the same team, thereby taking the trustee out of the middle. I submit that the trustee is not paid to be taken out of the middle. The trustee is paid to exercise discretion in both Collins, Savage, and Stampfli, “Financial Consequences of Distribution Elections from Total Return Trusts,” 35 Real Property., Probate & Trust Journal 243, 249 (Summer 2000). This is an excellent and well thought out article in which another group of economists conclude that fixed return unitrusts do not make economic sense. (Hereafter cited as “Collins.”) See also Collins and Stampfli, “Promises and Pitfalls of Total Return Trusts,” 27 ACTEC Journal 205 (2001). 12 28 ACTEC Journal 128 (2002) the investment and distribution arena unless a conscious decision is made to limit discretion in one of those areas. If the unitrust becomes the default drafting technique, the decision to remove discretion with respect to distributions will cease to be a deliberate (i.e., conscious) one. Note also that if there are allowable discretionary distributions in addition to the unitrust amount, the trustee is back in the middle. 4. Assumes a Financial Portfolio All of the market formulas in the unitrust assume that the trust estate is primarily financial assets —traded securities, bonds and cash. Many trusts have difficult to value assets which will not adapt to a fixed percentage of market value, and perhaps these assets will not even lend themselves to an annuity approach or a formula based on the S&P average return and bond returns (as discussed below). The valuation of non-financial assets must be dealt with in the trust and that may add a significant expense to the trust administration. Such expense will dramatically reduce return because of the compounding effect. One obvious consideration is that a fixed return unitrust (regardless of the formula) does not work well with non-financial assets. This same problem is present with the GiveMe-Five Trust, discussed below. a. Real Estate If the trust contains income producing real property, then so long as the income remains relatively stable, the trust can meet its obligations (assuming that the return to the beneficiary was not set too high). In addition to the expense of reappraisals, a slump in the real estate market or the ranching or farming business, depending upon the nature of the asset, could make it impossible for the trustee to meet its obligations. And, as a practical matter, the trustee, in order to make required distributions, would then be forced to sell off all of the real estate (or at least all of one of the pieces of real estate) since there is no real market for undivided interests. Or, to make distributions, the trustee might try to borrow, when obtaining credit is very difficult, and borrowing to make distributions is of questionable prudence.13 The problem is even greater if the trust has a large percentage of nonincome producing realty. b. Oil and Gas Oil and gas interests are probably the least desirable type of asset to be used in a unitrust. Because prices for these commodities are very volatile, any sort of fixed payout will be very difficult to meet. Valuation of these kinds of assets is also very difficult. And a forced sale by the trustee in a down market VI. SOME BASIC FALLACIES IN THE RUSH TO FIXED RETURN UNITRUSTS A. The Theory Is Untested All of the sturm und drang surrounding the use of the unitrust has arisen over the last few years. Thus, the unitrusts created are largely non-operational, and, if operational, have been in existence for only a short period of time. Thus, it is far too early to say with any certainty how these trusts will operate over a long period of time. I realize that this argument is advanced against any new or different technique, and that, if new techniques were not tried, there could be no progress. However, I believe that the analysis has been basically in the economic area, with little or no regard to the very likely human component of trust distributions. B. Trusts That Are Invested the Same Way Produce the Same Result Almost all the illustrations which are used to A distribution of an undivided interest, while theoretically possible, is not realistic. There are valuation issues, but, more importantly, the trustee is no longer in total control of the Property. 14 Collins, at 269. 13 could prove disastrous. c. Closely Held Business Interests If a closely held business interest is part of the trust estate, many of the same problems exist as with real estate, especially if the trustee cannot control the business’s dividend or distribution policy. And there may well, and probably would be restrictions on disposition of such interest by the trustee, even if there were a market. d. Limited Partnership Interests While a form of a closely held business interest, this type of asset has even more valuation problems and if all the trustee holds is an assignee interest, the problems are even greater. Again, since the trustee may be unable to sell the asset, and cannot even influence distributions, how can it meet a mandatory distribution standard? 5. Difficulty of Administration While the advocates of unitrusts argue that simplicity in administration is an attribute, these trusts are, in reality, somewhat difficult to administer even without hard to value assets, in that the trustee must be very careful in the valuation of the assets in a unitrust or the calculation of the annuity interest. Further, because of the inflexibility of distributions, the trustee must carefully monitor the trust and adjust investments so that the cash flow to pay the fixed distributions in a unitrust can be maintained without jeopardizing the future value of the trust. Since the distribution policy must drive the asset allocation, the trustee must consistently monitor the investments to assure the ability to meet the fixed requirements of a unitrust or annuity trust.14 28 ACTEC Journal 129 (2002) demonstrate the superiority of investment performance of the total return unitrust assume that the unitrust (because there is no need to invest to produce income) will be a largely equity based portfolio, while the “all income” trust (because of the “need” to produce income) will be invested at least one half in fixed income which will not increase in value, and thus the unitrust will outperform the all income trust. This is only true if the trust provides for no principal distributions (and some relief such as UPAIA §104) is not available. If the trustee has discretion to distribute principal to the income beneficiary, then the trustee is free to invest for overall return. No matter what the distribution standard, two trusts invested in the same manner will produce the same investment results. The two trusts will not perform identically over the long term because the distributions will be different, but there is no way to compare such performance. C. Ignores Human Nature One of the arguments for the unitrust, as noted above, is that all classes of beneficiaries prosper or suffer together and thereby peace and harmony will reign, the income beneficiary sheep will lie down with the remainderman lamb, and all beneficiaries will beat their swords into plowshares and their spears into pruning hooks. Of course, this ignores a basic tenet of human behavior—greed is a stronger force than gravity. D. Bull Markets Make the Unitrust Hum. Advocates of the unitrust say that while there may be some difficulties in a down market, there is no doubt that a bull market will produce only happy beneficiaries as the distributions and the value of the trust both rise. I submit that the following scenario is not only reasonably possible, but reasonably probable: Assume bull markets such as the last 5 years of the 20th Century, and that in that time span the value of a $3,000,000 portfolio increased in year one to $3,750,000, while the 4% beneficiary’s distribution increased from $120,000 to $150,000. And in year two, the portfolio increased from $3,750,000 to $4,5000,00, again producing a $30,000 increase in annual distributions. Now, the beneficiary looks around and says to the trustee, “In the last two years the portfolio has increased by $1.5 million, and I got a lousy $60,000 increase in distributions. I’m not going to live forever you know, so I want more of the gravy now.” The flip side, of course, is that in a bear market the current beneficiary is likely to ask, “Just because the value of the trust went down, why should I suffer?” Somehow, I doubt that the trustee’s explanation that it is following VII. THE ECONOMICS OF THE UNITRUST There are several potential designs for total return trusts, as set forth below in the drafting examples. Each of these designs, of course, has its own economic effects, but there are some general propositions which can be applied to all. This section seeks to examine the general types of total return trusts, along with certain economic effects. A. Types of Trusts The total return trusts fall generally into five categories. 1. Unitrusts The distribution, or payout, is tied to the market value of this type of trust, usually at annual intervals. In order to avoid extreme short term swings, it is generally suggested by the proponents of this trust that some average over a period of time be used to create a “smoothing” effect. Generally, such terms are three to five years. 2. Fixed Payout Trusts Not Tied to Value or Market Averages The annuity trust has the advantage of predictability and does not tie distributions to the current value of the trust. As noted earlier, distributions from this type of trust are almost always counter-cyclical, and, in a prolonged downturn, could impair the viability of the trust. 3. Trusts with a Discretionary Distribution Standard. These types of trust divide into basically three types: (i) purely discretionary, (ii) mandatory income with pure discretion as to principal, and (iii) mandatory income with discretion as to principal limited to a standard such as HEMS. In each of these cases, the trustee can invest for overall return because it has the flexibility to make discretionary distributions. A discretionary payout with a cap based on value might have some of the best (or perhaps the worst) attributes of the variations on fixed payout trusts. 4. Fixed Payout Based on Market Averages15 James P. Garland, while purporting to argue against unitrusts, is really only opposed to the fixed percentage of market value unitrusts. He actually favors the unitrust approach, but with a formula tied to market performance. He argues that spending tied This idea is vigorously supported by James P. Garland, who has set out his position clearly and eloquently in Garland, “The Problems with Unitrusts,” The Journal of Private Portfolio Man- agement, Vol. I, No. 4, Spring, 1999. A helpful source of references is included at the end of the article for those interested in delving more deeply into this morass. 15 28 ACTEC Journal 130 (2002) the trust design will suffice, any more than the explanation that the trustee cannot distribute more than the HEMS standard in a discretionary trust employing that standard satisfies the income beneficiary. to value places the ability to provide for the income beneficiary beyond control of the trustee, since it cannot control market fluctuations. In fact, two bad results will accrue if the fixed percent of value unitrust is used because of the desire of a trustee to avoid substantial swings in trust distributions: (i) practical considerations will force a trustee away from more equities, and (ii) the trustees will engage in market timing, a proven failure under modern investing standards. Finally, although troughs have been of relatively short durations in recent years, the market has historically experienced troughs as long as 10 years, and even longer if adjusted for inflation. Therefore, Garland champions a payout based upon some percentage of earnings on the S&P 500 plus the real bond yield (perhaps averaged over some short period) of mid-term treasury bonds. “Real bond yield” is the stated interest rate on the bond less inflation; e.g., If the stated interest is 5%, and inflation is 3%, then the real bond yield is 2%. By tying the return to earnings in the market place, fluctuations are smoothed. And that is the basic argument for this approach—that the amount of real dollars received by the income beneficiary is predictable, even though the percent of value approach could have produced much more in bull markets such as we enjoyed until recently. 5. The “Give-Me-Five” Trust. Jerry Horn is a staunch advocate of the “Give-Me-Five” approach to distributions in which the current beneficiary is given the right to draw down up to 5% of the value of the trust, the 5% number being based on Code §2041(b) which allows the lapse of a general power over 5% of a trust without any adverse transfer tax results. Mr. Horn bases this approach on the surmise that most clients would leave property outright if given a choice, but there are real asset protection, tax and other benefits to the use of trusts. Therefore, the trust should come as close to outright ownership as possible. He argues, as do I, that the unitrust or annuity trust approach is too inflexible, and this approach is his answer as to how to let the trustee invest for total return and still maintain the desired flexibility. The pros and cons will be discussed below in the drafting section. From an economic standpoint, this approach at least lets the beneficiary determine how much the payout from the trust should be. B. Economic Considerations In contemplating the efficacy of a fixed percent of market value unitrust, there are certain economic realties and problems to be considered, some of which may not be too obvious. These arguments are 16 succinctly summarized by David Levine and may be found in Appendix C (see Table of Contents). 1. History as a Predictor A centerpiece of the arguments as to the type of unitrust, the spending policies and the efficacy of such policies is the debate as to the reliability of history as a predictor. If, for instance, dividend policies of the past could be arithmetically applied to the future, dividend yields would eventually go to zero, and price/earnings ratios would go to 300%. In that environment, a fixed percent of value unitrust would continue to work well. But remember that a fall in prices has historically produced a higher dividend yield as a percent of value. But prices have been falling for over a year now, and not only have dividend yields as a percent of value not risen, actual dividends have been reduced or eliminated. While I believe that historical trends can be useful in certain areas, I also believe that they are valid only in the short run. Electing a distribution formula based primarily on successful historical results is not a good decision....When suggested distribution formulae are back tested against historical results, the methodological flaw is known as “data mining.”16 The one certainty is that things will change. This belief that history is not an accurate predictor is the very heart and soul of the Random Walk theory. 2. Use of Averages in Projections In the vast majority of projections I have seen of the long-term effects of the unitrust, an assumed growth rate has been used to illustrate the results of the unitrust over a long period of time. Because of this, the illustration is at best misleading, since the growth will not be steady, but, rather, it will be cyclical. Thus, to fully understand the effects of the unitrust, projections should contain some periods of higher return and some of lower than the average anticipated long term growth. While the projections will undoubtedly not be accurate as to the timing of the cycles, it will demonstrate the distribution swings that the beneficiary can expect and the effect of such swings on the long term prospects of the trust. Projections without the cyclical calculations demonstrate a fallacy referred to as the “expected value” fallacy. That fallacy postulates that, based on historical data, bad years will be offset by good years and, therefore, Collins, at 245. 28 ACTEC Journal 131 (2002) wealth accumulations and portfolio distribution will remain on track. These principles are illustrated by the graphs attached as Appendix B-1 through Appendix B-12.18 These graphs use a three year smoothing formula and assume that capital gains are paid from the trust and are not distributed as DNI. They are based upon two investment paradigms—an all equity fund represented by the S & P 500, and a “balanced” 60% equity (represented by the S&P 500)-40% bond (represented by the Lehman Bros. intermediate bond index) mix. There are three time periods shown, and it is particularly interesting to note the impact of the bull market of the last five years of the twentieth century and the difference that the time period chosen makes. Utilizing the almost 30-year time period from 1973 through 2001, Appendix B-1 illustrates the distributions to the beneficiary based upon actual S&P performance versus average performance. For most of the period, the actual performance distributions trailed the compounded average of 12.01%, but in 1997, after the lower years disappeared from the smoothing base, the actual returns from the bull market of that period surpassed the average. The same is true of the account balance illustrated in Appendix B-2. The actual account balance starts to exceed the average account balance in 1995 (unrestrained by smoothing). But, note that the drop in 2000 and 2001 was steep enough to bring the actual year end value below the average again. This is an accurate predictor of what will happen to distributions when the bull market years drop out of the smoothing formula. And, even though the actual total distributions to the beneficiary over that period total more than the illustrated returns using the compound average, the beneficiary’s actual distributions trail the average distributions by a substantial amount. The balanced portfolio follows much the same parameters, although the returns are less volatile, but ending balances are substantially less. (See Appendices B-3 and B-4). The 20-year period beginning in 1982 shows, not surprisingly, the same results as the longer period, although the compounding rate of 15.24% skews the results a little bit more. (See Appendices B4 to B-8.) If, however, we choose the 20 year period from 1973-1992 in which the average S&P compound rate is 11.33%, then actual distributions always trail the averages. This is also true in the balanced portfolio model. (See Appendices B-9 to B-12.) So what do all these numbers mean other than that many of us who write in this area love to put charts together. (Truth be told, I am not really that fond of economic modeling.) The bottom line is that the period chosen and the indices chosen dramatically impact the results, and that averages have no relation to actual. As noted by Collins, the beneficiary cannot rely on averages. He or she must live year to year with the actual results. 3. Volatility Using a 60-40 asset allocation, there is wide fluctuation of the return to the beneficiary in real dollars. Mr. Garland, in the article cited earlier, measured the spending from a 5% market value unitrust from 1951 through 1998. In 1951 dollars, such spending ranged from $1 in 1951 to $1.84 in 1986, to $0.756 in 1981, and back to $1.938 in the bull market of 1998 (before the dip experienced in 1999). Using a market return of 125% of the earnings of the S&P 500 companies only, the volatility was from a high of $1.385 in 1966 to a low of $0.931 in 1986 and $1.136 in 1998. So, if the desire is for stability, the earnings model is much more predictable than the percent of market value.19 Mr. Garland’s analysis demonstrates even more volatility as the portfolio tends toward a greater percent of equities. The return is always higher in the 80% to 100% equity mode, but a good deal more volatile. Volatility can be better tolerated so long as everything goes up, especially in nominal terms which would produce even more dramatic results. However, in a sustained drop involving a fixed return unitrust based upon a percentage of value, problems will invariably develop. Id., at 282-3. The illustrations use nominal rather than real returns. The author is indebted to the Kentor Company, Austin, Texas for its assistance in preparing these graphs. 19 This illustration was developed in connection with expendi- tures by non-profits from endowments and thus ignores the effect of income taxes. There is a greater virtue in predictability in the non-profit arena, but it is achieved by failing to take advantage of upswings in the market to increase distributions. In the private sector, the beneficiary likes the increase in an up market. Consider, for example, an intoxicated person wandering down the middle of the road. As he progresses, he wanders outside of the double yellow lines (the zone of safety). Sometimes he stumbles to the left (into oncoming traffic) and sometimes to the right (also into traffic). The average position of the intoxicated person is in the safety zone. However, the average physical state of the intoxicated person...is injury or death.17 17 18 28 ACTEC Journal 132 (2002) Indeed...the formula fails to fulfill the grantor’s objectives with respect to the remainderman in approximately 18% of the trials. On average, the formula works. However, the remainder beneficiary cannot rely on the average result and must accept the actual result.20 4. Inability to Protect the Real Value In addition to volatility in distributions, using the 60%-40% model and taking into account administrative costs, taxes and inflation, a requirement to distribute all the income will cause a real long term loss in value in the income stream and in the value of the trust estate. In real terms, two economists calculated that the value of $1,000,000 invested in 1960 would be worth only $677,000 in 1995, and the real income in 1960 dollars from that amount would have dropped from $25,000 to $22,000.21 Using the greater of all income or a 4% mandatory payout22 may cause the trust to lose enough value that it will expire during its term and prior to the termination date stated in the instrument, depending upon its net after tax return. Thus, the all income or mandatory fixed percent unitrust may not protect either the remainderman or the income beneficiary, and putting the two standards together only exacerbates the problem. AUTHOR’S NOTE: Messrs. Hertog’s and Levine’s study concluded in 1995 and thus does not include the phenomenal upward spiral of the market in the succeeding five years. However, as we have learned since the spring of 2000, and, as the Random Walk theory would confirm, past price trends are not necessarily a predictor of future price trends. Thus, while the Hertog-Levine study results would clearly have been different in the 1995-2000 period, that period may not be reflective of the future. 5. “Excess” Distributions of Bond Interest Some economists argue that bond interest reflects not only real return but in part a payback on inflation. Bonds are valuable in a portfolio in that they decrease volatility and provide a more stable return Collins, at 251. Hertog and Levine, “Income versus Wealth: Making the Trade Off,” 5-1 The Journal of Investing 1, (Spring 1996) 22 This formula was often advocated to meet QTIP requirements. The Proposed Regulations under §643(b) will allow a fixed return unitrust to meet the “all income” requirement in states which adopt a unitrust statute. See discussion of the Proposed Regula20 21 than do stocks. So long as the stated rate of bond interest is higher than the unitrust amount, the excess of the stated rate over the unitrust amount is “automatically” plowed back into principal or capital. However, this proposition only holds true if the value of the bond is at par or below. If, because of lower interest rates on newer bonds the value is in excess of par, then more than the stated interest rate would be paid out as the unitrust amount. Assume a 4% unitrust rate and a $10,000 municipal bond with a rate of 5%. The unitrust amount would be $100 less than the trust received, therefore allowing that $100 to be reinvested. However, if the bond were valued at a 25% premium ($12,500) or higher, the payout would be equal to or greater than the amount received. This might force the trustee to sell the bond to realize the premium and reinvest at a lower rate, which might again force the unitrust payout to be greater than the stated rate. 6. A Summary of the Effects of the Various Policies Mr. Levine has prepared a summary showing the effects of the various types of distribution formulae. While Mr. Wolf disagrees with the formulation, it is an interesting exercise. The analysis is part of Appendix C-1, including the Unstressed and Stressed scenarios.23 Both illustrations are expressed in real (i.e., inflation adjusted) dollars. “Modified Garland” is the Garland approach wherein interest returns are adjusted for inflation. The calculation as to when the trust goes broke, assumes that the trustee has the power to invade in excess of the fixed distribution, and exercises that discretion to maintain the spending power of the dollar. None of these will reduce to zero without that consideration. In analyzing the Unstressed scenario, a 6040 mix of equities and fixed income closely approximates the Modified Garland +1% results. Obviously in the 100% equities scenario, the all income beneficiary fares substantially worse, and the Modified Garland +2% approximates the 2.5% unitrust. The Stressed scenario postulates a first year bear market with a 70% loss in value,24 a first year rise in interest rates of 4% and a rise in inflation of 3% from 2.4% to 5.4%. (We can all agree that this is a great deal of “stress”). The important part of this analysis is that the value of the trust decreases dramatically using the 4% unitrust. tions below. 23 The boxes on the Unstressed illustration indicate corrections made from previously distributed projections. 24 Not so long ago, this magnitude of drop in value would have seemed not only improbable, but even impossible. Once again, history has not proved to be a reliable predictor. 28 ACTEC Journal 133 (2002) VIII. ACCOMPLISHMENT OF CLIENT’S OBJECTIVE AND SOME SURPRISING THINGS YOU MAY NOT HAVE THOUGHT ABOUT As stated earlier, and the proposition cannot be restated too often, the primary consideration in drafting a trust is to meet the client’s objectives. The corollary to that, of course, is that the client must understand the effect of the trust design chosen. The advocates of private unitrusts point out that all income formulations are almost certain not to meet client objectives and to create tension between the income beneficiary and the remainder beneficiary. Further, they argue, all income formulations (i) practically assure that the trustee’s investment philosophy will focus more on increasing current return than on overall return and (ii) put the trustee at a disadvantage in maximizing return. The discretionary trust, while allowing investment for overall return, still creates tension between the temporal and permanent interests. A. Focus Should Be on the “Real” Beneficiary Remember that the underlying philosophy of the unitrust is to assure certain benefits to the current beneficiary and have some left over for the remainderman. So, the first step in designing the trust is to determine whether that assumption accurately reflect’s the testator’s wishes. In many cases, the testator may desire to benefit the current beneficiary without regard to the interests of later beneficiaries; e.g., the first spouse to die may wish to provide lavishly for the survivor, and whatever is left for the children, they are welcome to. In other instances, it may be the desire of the testator to assure that the next generation is amply provided for, without any concern for generations beyond that; e.g., one spouse may wish to provide assistance for a surviving second spouse, but assure that the children of the first spouse have a substantial portion of the assets left to enjoy. It is almost impossible to extend the distribution standard beyond the beneficiary or beneficiaries for whom the trust was created because of the impossibility to predict with any degree of certainty future economic conditions, both macro and in the case of an individual beneficiary. While it may be possible to determine spending objectives through the child’s generation, it certainly is not realistic to try to formulate spending to the generation beyond that. So, even in drafting a unitrust formula for a dynasty type trust, the draftsman may still be faced with the task of determining distribution standards for future generations. There is, it appears to me, a certain logical inconsistency in advocating unitrusts because they hone in on the settlor’s concrete desire to provide a specific type of benefit for the current beneficiary 28 ACTEC Journal 134 (2002) and then extend that specific desire to future generations whose needs may be entirely different. Thus, in a dynasty trust, at least two different spending formulas may need to be considered. 1. Understanding the Difference Between Distributions, Spending and Return “Return” is the amount earned by the trust, and total return includes both income and realized and unrealized capital gains. “Distributions” are the amount distributed to the beneficiary. “Spending” is the actual amount available to be spent after taxes and costs, and may be applied at both the trust and beneficiary level, depending upon allocation of expenses and taxes. For example, if the grantor or the trustee allocates capital gains to the trust, and if a portion of the 4% distribution is capital gains, the spending by the beneficiary is increased because a portion is free from tax. Likewise, the spending by the trust has increased beyond 4%. The converse is true if the capital gains are included in distributable net income. Although the beneficiary receives the same amount of dollars, he or she has less available to spend because of the allocation of taxes. This is an extremely important concept in drafting fixed percent interest unitrust provisions. 2. Understanding Whether the Client’s Desires Can Be Met Once the spending desires are determined, the next point in the analysis is whether the client’s expectations can be met. This involves projecting whether the trust can reasonably sustain the spending desired by the settlor. It is possible, if these projections are not carefully done, that the trust will not be able to sustain the spending even during the life expectancy of the current beneficiary. If under the plan ultimately adopted, the trustee is expected to exercise its discretion in such a manner as to substantially diminish the trust during the life of the current beneficiary, that should be specifically noted in the trust instrument so that the trustee can feel comfortable in so doing. A general provision to prefer the current beneficiary may not be sufficient. A suggested provision might be as follows: I have given consideration as to the benefits to be conferred under this trust, and my desire is to benefit my children in the manner stated without regard to the interest of more remote beneficiaries. In fact, I recognize that the distribution directions may well deplete the trust in its entirety, and I direct the trustee to invest with a view to being able to maintain such distributions during the life of my child without regard to the preservation of assets beyond the life of my child. The trustee shall have no liability to more remote beneficiaries for following such direction. 3. Real Returns The formula must take into account that the client probably desires to maintain the spending in terms of real dollars—dollars that take inflation (or deflation) into account. The total return trust clauses below do make such adjustments for inflation in an annuity context, but rely on valuation to automatically adjust returns in percentage of value unitrust formulas. 4. Costs It is very easy to ignore the effect of costs on the anticipated return. Taking into account the effect of compounding, such very real and expensive factors cannot be ignored. In fact, their effect on the overall return can be staggering. During the period 1926-1997, the compound mean annual return of large capitalization U.S. stocks as represented by the S&P 500 stocks, after inflation (which ran at a compound annual rate of 3.1%), was 7.9% and for smaller companies 9.6%. A 1% annual management fee that was not offset by at least some increase in investment return would have reduced this average large capitalization equity return (after inflation) by about 12% and the average smaller capitalization equity return by something on the order of 10%. made in kind. This phenomenon is relatively easily understood upon a small amount of reflection. 1. Effect of Smoothing If the unitrust percentage is applied to an average (three or five years being the most commonly used), then by definition the beneficiary will not receive 4% of the present value of the trust. When the value of the trust is increasing, the growth in the beneficiary’s distribution lags behind the growth in the value of the trust. Conversely, as the value of the trust trends downward, the beneficiary’s distribution will not decrease as rapidly as the value of the trust is declining. Depending upon the length and steepness of the decline, the trust may be dissipated at a very rapid rate, thereby causing a diminution in value which will impair future distributions and the remaining value of the trust. These results are dramatically illustrated above in ¶VII.B.2 “Use of Averages in Projections.” 2. Effect of Tax Allocation. If capital gains taxes are allocated to DNI, then the value of the trust is increased, increasing the annual distributions. However, the real effect may be to reduce the spending by the beneficiary, because while the beneficiary is receiving more funds, he or she will have to pay more taxes. If the taxes are paid by the trust, then over a long period of time, even assuming a very low turnover, the payment of taxes can substantially affect the ending value of the trust. (See Appendices D-1 and D-2.) Obviously, whether taxes (a very real cost) are allocated to the current beneficiary or to the trust can also dramatically affect returns. B. The One Thing the Beneficiary of a 4% Unitrust Never Gets Is 4%. One of the principal things the client must understand is that the distribution from the unitrust after the initial period will never be the stated percent if smoothing is used, if capital gains taxes are allocated to the beneficiary or, in some cases, if distributions are IX. LEGISLATIVE APPROACHES IN GENERAL As of the date of this writing 37 states have adopted UPIA, so that it is clear that the Prudent Investor Rule in Restatement of the Law of Trusts, Third, is the law in most jurisdictions. However, the adoption of UPIA will not solve the problems with existing trusts in light of modern portfolio theory. It also will not deal with the multitude of trusts which will be drafted after its passage either because the tax laws will still require all income formulations, or just because of inertia in changing forms. Remember that the proposed regulations under §643(b) only expand the definition of income. They do not change the statutory all income requirement, and they are not effective until final. In order to deal with existing trusts and provide flexibility for trusts in the future, there are two basic and non-exclusive legislative approaches being taken, an optin unitrust26 and UPAIA’s §10427 creating a trustee’s right 25 William L. Hoisington, Modern Trust Designs, ©1999 which was an update and expansion of his article for the Heckerling Institute, cited supra. 26 As of the date of this writing, 12 states have passed statutes dealing with opt-in unitrusts, with legislation pending in two other states. 27 As of the date of this writing, UPAIA has been adopted in 24 states, and is being considered for adoption in 6 other jurisdictions. In some of those jurisdictions, it has been adopted without §104, and in others, such as Alabama, §104 has been made applicable only to trusts created after the effective date. Over the last 25 years, a 10%12% lower compound annual return reduced ending real wealth by about 20%.25 28 ACTEC Journal 135 (2002) to reallocate between income and principal. These approaches are not mutually exclusive. The application of UPAIA §104 allowing the trustee to reallocate what would be characterized as principal receipts to income, and vice versa, concerns only trusts which mandate distributions in terms of income, and have a trustee other than the beneficiary making such reallocations. If a trustee wants to opt into the statutory unitrust, a trustee must, as a practical matter, seek approval from the beneficiaries or the Court. (The statutes usually gives the trustee the ability to opt in or out in its discretion, but I believe that would take a very brave trustee.) X. UPAIA UPAIA deals with the mandatory income trust with no invasion power (or a limited invasion power) by allowing the trustee to reallocate receipts between income and principal. While it is easy in this environment to assume that receipts normally a part of principal will be reallocated to income, in other times receipts that are normally income could be reallocated to principal. A. The Power to Reallocate Section 104 is the answer of the National Conference of Commissioners on Uniform State Laws to the problem of how the trustee can be impartial and invest for overall return while being mandated to pay all the income of the trust to the income beneficiary. Remember that this power to reallocate is not a panacea for all existing trusts since it is not available if the trustee is the beneficiary. 1. Trustee’s Power to Reallocate—UPAIA §104 The proposed statute would give a trustee the power to “adjust between principal and income to the extent the trustee considers advisable to enable the trustee to make appropriate present and future distributions....” (The italicized language is the standard under the Uniform Prudent Investor Act.) To invoke this power, (i) the prudent investor rule must apply to the trust, (ii) the trust must describe distributions in terms of income, (iii) the trustee must determine that such adjustment would be fair and reasonable, and (iv) such reallocation must give the income beneficiary use consistent with preservation of the property. The Act also lists factors that the Trustee is to consider in making such reallocation: a. the nature, purpose and duration of the trust; b. the intent of the creator of the trust; c. the identity and circumstances of the beneficiary; d. the need for liquidity, regularity of payment, and preservation and appreciation of capital; e. the assets held in the trust and their 28 ACTEC Journal 136 (2002) uses by the beneficiary; f. the net amount allocated to income under the other sections of UPAIA and the increase or decrease in the value of the principal assets; g. whether and to what extent the terms of the trust give the trustee the power to invade principal or accumulate income or prohibit the trustee from invading principal or accumulating income, and the extent to which the trustee has exercised a power from time to time to invade principal or accumulate income; h. the actual and anticipated effect of economic conditions on principal and income and effects of inflation and deflation; and i. the anticipated tax consequences of an adjustment. 2. Exception to Trustee’s Power to Reallocate The trustee may not make an adjustment: a. that diminishes the income interest for which the marital deduction would be allowed if the trustee did not have the power to make such adjustment; b. that reduces the actuarial value of the income interest in a trust to which a person transfers property with the intent to qualify for a gift tax exclusion; c. that changes the amount payable to a beneficiary as a fixed annuity or a fixed fraction of the value of the assets; d. from any amount that is permanently set aside for charitable purposes, unless income and principal are so set aside; e. if the holding or exercise of the power would cause the trust to be a grantor trust; f. if possessing the power would cause estate tax inclusion in the estate of a person possessing the power to remove and replace the trustee; g. if the trustee is a beneficiary (emphasis added); or h. if the beneficiary is not the trustee, but the trustee would benefit directly or indirectly. A trustee may release the power to reallocate if continuing to hold the power would produce a detrimental tax effect. Note that the emphasized phrase is very important in limiting the applicability of this section since spouses are often the trustee of QTIP trusts. 3. Application to Existing Trusts Since UPAIA applies to existing trusts from the date of its enactment, if the trust is governed by that Act and provides for distributions based upon income, the reallocation provisions will not be negated by a prohibition against invasion of principal or a bar against equitable adjustments. UPAIA is applicable to all trusts whether created on or after the effective date, unless specifically made inapplicable by the terms of the instrument or court decree. 4. Judicial Control of Discretionary Powers—New UPAIA §105 A new §105 of UPAIA was adopted by the National Conference of Commissioners on Uniform State Laws at their August, 2000, meeting in order to make it clear, as the commentary to that section states, that the discretionary powers in UPAIA (and specifically the power under §104) “are subject to the normal rules that govern a fiduciary’s exercise of discretion.” The rule referred to is that the trustee’s decisions should be reviewed on the basis of an abuse of discretion. The comments also make clear that the trustee must demonstrate that it exercised discretion after consideration of relevant factors. Mere inaction is failure to exercise discretion, not abuse of discretion, and therefore is not subject to the rule, citing Comment b, §50 of the Restatement of the Law of Trusts, Third. The remedies prescribed are first to make adjustments within the trust among the beneficiaries, and if it is not possible to do this, the trustee may be required to pay the beneficiaries and/or the trust to make everyone whole. The trustee has the authority to apply to the court to determine whether his action would be an abuse of discretion. If the petition makes sufficient disclosure, the burden of proving an abuse of discretion is on the beneficiary asserting the abuse, an almost impossible burden. 5. Will Trustees Exercise This Discretion? Proponents of the power of reallocation argue that this power is no different than the other discretionary powers trustees exercise in invading principal or in determining income distributions in a discretionary environment. Here, again, the draftsman can assist greatly by setting out the purpose of the trust, but that may not occur. The trustee’s willingness to exercise is obviously influenced by the terms of the trust. a. Trust Is Silent Perhaps, the most obvious situation is that in which the trust is simply silent as to invasion of principal. There, it would seem the trustee has a real basis for exercising this discretion. Absent language in the trust to the contrary, it is reasonable to believe that the creator of the trust would have wanted a sufficient amount of income to pass to the beneficiary and at the same time preserve the principal. The ability to invest for total return and still provide for the income beneficiary would seem almost to demand the exercise of this discretion. After all, the alternative is to invest to produce a sufficient amount of income at the expense of overall return. b. Trust Prohibits Invasion of Principal While on the surface it may seem that the trustee should not exercise discretion in this type of trust, the same reasons appertain as in the trust that is silent; i.e., absent a contrary indication in the instrument, the trustee must, in the exercise of its duty of impartiality, invest to produce a sufficient return for the income beneficiary, thereby potentially sacrificing a better overall return. An exercise of the ability to reallocate solves this problem and should not be seen as a prohibited invasion of principal. c. Trust Provides for HEMS Standard If the trust provides for principal invasion subject to a standard, and if the income beneficiary does not need such principal distributions, then should the trustee reallocate? Again, absent some guidance in the instrument, the trustee may choose to exercise the §104 power to satisfy its duty of impartiality. Once again, the issue is whether it is better to invest for overall return, and that has been decided by the adoption of UPIA, a prerequisite to the application of §104. Analyzed in this manner, the choice is not how much the income beneficiary gets, but whether the trust should be invested for overall return in accordance with the law of the state. The inclusion of §104 has met with resistance in some states considering the adoption of UPAIA, and §105 is obviously designed to alleviate some of the concerns trustees may have with §104. 6. How Will the Trustee Exercise This Discretion? If the trustee is willing to exercise the discretion under UPAIA §104, how will the trustee exercise the discretion? One option is for the trustee to wait until the end of the year, see what the actual income is and then adjust to what it deems to be a fair return for the beneficiary in whose favor the adjustment is made. However, that is a little cumbersome, but quarterly adjustments might not work a lot better. Another approach is to project the income and overall return for the year, and make adjustments off the projections. That might be a little risky in a volatile or downward trending market. The approach most likely to be adopted by the trustee is a unitrust approach, with the percentage determined at or near the beginning of the year based on closing values for the preceding year as determined by the trustee. This is certainly easier than the mandated unitrust because the flexibility is so much greater since the trustee is not bound by a mandated formula. However, will the trustee, having once determined a unitrust percentage for one year, carefully review that percentage every year? Or will the trustee in effect use the reallocation power simply to convert the trust to a unitrust? This approach (as with the more formal unitrust) will not work very well with trusts containing non-financial assets. 28 ACTEC Journal 137 (2002) XI. STATE OPT-IN STATUTES As noted above, 12 states have adopted statutes which allow the conversion of an all income trust to a unitrust either upon action by the trustee or requests by the beneficiary. This approach is thought to be solve the problem when UPAIA §104 is not available, and, also, arguably, provides all of the benefits as if the grantor had been far sighted enough to draft a unitrust in the first place.. The proposed §643(b) Regulations, and their expected promulgation as final regulations, has added impetus to this rush by several states to enact unitrust conversion statutes.28 A. New York’s Initial Attempt New York, while not the first state to adopt a unitrust conversion statute, was the first state to seriously consider so doing, and clearly provided the basis for the present wave of statutes. In connection with New York’s desire to adopt the prudent investor rule, a statute was proposed that would establish a 4% fixed income unitrust as a default rule; i.e., if the trust provided that the trustee was to distribute all the income to the beneficiary, that would be interpreted to mean that the trustee was required to distribute 4% of the value of the trust. This could only be overridden by specific direction in the instrument. After that initial recommendation met with some serious opposition, the statute was changed in several key aspects, the most important of which is that the unitrust would become an opt-in rather than a default; i.e., the unitrust approach would operate only if chosen by the trustee or directed by the court. The New York experience would lead me to believe that it would be very difficult in any jurisdiction to get the unitrust legislated in as a default provision. B. The Variations Among States A detailed analysis of the statutes of the various jurisdictions is beyond the scope of this paper, but there are clearly differences in approach and quality. For example, the New York statute is extremely detailed in both the terms of the trust and the procedures to be followed in converting. The Missouri statute is almost skeletal in comparison, and the Pennsylvania statute is somewhere in between. New Jersey has a “safe harbor” approach and Delaware allows a fluctuating amount. What all of these statutes (other than New York and possibly Pennsylvania) have in common is that they were cobbled together very quickly, there is not even an attempt at any kind of uniformity, and there certainly was not time between concept and enactment for a great deal of reflection. It will be interesting to see how, or if, these statutes are utilized and what the long term effect will be.29 C. Considerations Prior to Converting The considerations as to whether to convert to a unitrust under the statute are much the same as those to be considered in deciding whether to use a unitrust originally. 1. Desire of the Beneficiaries It would take a very bold trustee to decide to opt into a unitrust if at least the vast majority of most classes of beneficiaries do not agree. As discussed below, accurate projections of the effect of the conversion is of ultimate importance. And if the performance of the trust varies widely from the projections, the trustee can be almost certain that some beneficiaries are going to feel (allege?) that they were not given complete and accurate information. 2. Availability of UPAIA §104 If UPAIA §104 is available under state law, I believe that it is almost always better to use that approach rather than the conversion to a unitrust. As indicated above, the trustee will probably do the §104 reallocation so that the payout is essentially a unitrust payout, with the major difference being that the trustee has the flexibility to change the percentage and even the approach to the reallocation or to stop the reallocation entirely if situations change. 3. Composition of the Trust Oddly enough, the trust in which it may be most difficult to produce income is a trust which contains non-financial assets, and it is exactly those assets which are the most difficult to deal with in a unitrust context. 4. Projections The trustee should run projections under several different scenarios. (We are now much wiser than to believe that the only scenario is always and consistently up.) It is very important that such projections be based on different returns for different periods rather than an average consistent growth rate. Even though the timing will not be accurate, the benefit is to show the beneficiary and the trustee the possible effects of different markets and that averages do not apply in the real world when distributions are made on an annual basis. 28 Texas will probably take a different approach and enact a statute that will allow a unitrust, drafted as such, to qualify for the marital deduction upon the issuance of final regulations, but would not allow for conversion to a unitrust without following the trust modification procedures under existing law. 29 As of the date of this writing, the following states have adopted unitrust conversion statutes: Delaware, Florida, Illinois, Iowa, Maine, Maryland, Missouri, New Hampshire, New York, Pennsylvania, South Dakota and Washington. New Jersey and Louisiana have adopted unitrust safe harbor statutes. Legislation is pending in two other states. 28 ACTEC Journal 138 (2002) XII. THE IRS RESPONSE TO MODERN PORTFOLIO THEORY AND THE “ALL INCOME” TRUST One of the major issues in the drafting of total return trusts is whether such trusts would meet the all income requirement for marital deduction trusts. This same issue surrounds the application of UPAIA §104. On February 15, 2001, the Service published Proposed Rules on Trust Income Definition.30 These proposed regulations, according to the Summary, revise “the definition of income under section 643(b)...to take into account changes in the definition of trust accounting income under state laws.” The proposed regulations also deal with capital gains as a part of distributable net income (“DNI”), charitable issues, marital deduction issues, and generation skipping issues. The proposed regulations become effective on publication of final regulations in the Federal Register. A. Amendment to Definition of Income. The proposed regulations revising §1.643(b)-1 maintain the old position that trust provisions defining income which depart from accepted accounting procedures will not be recognized. The proposed regulations go on to provide: However, amounts allocated between income and principal pursuant to applicable local law will be respected if local law provides for a reasonable apportionment between the income and the remainder beneficiaries of the total return trust for the year, including ordinary income, capital gains, and appreciation. The proposed regulations then give the specific example of a 3%-5% unitrust31 or “equitable adjustments” under state law. There are other requirements for the application of equitable adjustments: (1) the trust is managed under the prudent investor rule; (2) the trust describes distributions in terms of the income of the trust; and, (3) the trustee, after applying the statutory rules regarding allocation of principal and income is unable to administer the trust impartially. An allocation of capital gains to income is recognized if made pursuant to the terms of the governing instrument or local law, or “pursuant to a reasonable and consistent exercise of a discretionary power granted to the fiduciary.” There is an interesting question as to how the exercise can be “consistent” at least the first time it is exercised. Perhaps some statement of the intent to do so in the trust’s records would be sufficient. 30 REG-106513-00, amending primarily Treas. Regs. §1.643(b)-1, but also making conforming amendments to other regulations. 31 Although the proposed regulation refers specifically to a B. Capital Gains Allocated to DNI and Capital Losses. In addition to those situations in which capital gains are included in DNI under the existing regulations, the proposed regulation §1.643(a)-(3) permits capital gains to be included in DNI if so allocated by the fiduciary pursuant to a reasonable and consistent exercise of discretion in the following situations: (1) allocated to income; (2) allocated to corpus but treated as part of a distribution to a beneficiary; or (3) allocated to corpus but used in determining the amount distributed or required to be distributed to a beneficiary. Note that, in a unitrust, either the governing instrument must deal with the allocation of capital gains or the state statute must if there is a statutory opt in. Capital losses are netted against capital gains at the trust level except for those used under (3) in determining the amount to be distributed to a particular beneficiary. C. Distributions in Kind Treas. Regs. §1.651(a)-2 is amended by adding a new subsection (d) which treats distributions in kind from an all income trust as a sale by the trust on the date of distribution, but permits a §651 deduction if no more than the amount of DNI is distributed. Treas. Regs. §1.661(a)-2(f) is substantially revised to provide that gain or loss is recognized by the trust or estate if property is distributed in kind in satisfaction of a requirement to distribute income currently. D. Charitable Remainder Unitrust There is a unique problem with Charitable Remainder Unitrusts (“CRUT”) which use income as the measure of the unitrust amount. Federal law requires that the CRUT unitrust amount be not less than 5%. If a unitrust provides for payment of the lesser of the income of the CRUT or a defined unitrust amount, and if there is a state statute defining income as a unitrust amount of 4%, then the CRUT will fail to meet the 5% test since net income (as defined by statute) will always be less than the designated unitrust amount. The proposed regulations deal with this by requiring that the instrument contain its own definition of income which is consistent with the CRUT rules. Additionally, capital gains attributable to appreciation after its contribution to the trust may be allocated to income pursuant to the terms of the governing instrument and state law, but not in the discretion of the trustee. 3%-5% unitrust, this would also presumably apply to an annuity approach with an inflation adjustment provision. It should, logically, also apply to the Give-Me Five approach. 28 ACTEC Journal 139 (2002) E. Marital Deduction Provisions Language is added in the proposed amendments to Treas. Regs. §20.2056(b)-5(f)(1) so that the all income requirement is met: “In addition...if the spouse is entitled to income as defined by a state statute that provides for a reasonable apportionment between the income and remainder beneficiaries of the total return of the trust and that meets the requirements of section 1.643(b)-1 of this chapter.” Although comments on the Proposed Regulations have noted that a unitrust formula or an equitable allocation clause should be available to meet the all income test even if the state has not adopted a unitrust statute or UPAIA §104, the Service has indicated that is not the result under the proposed regulations, and probably will not be under the final regulations. Because of the specificity of the Proposed Regulations, will they override the more general test concerning the all income requirement contained above in the Regulations? Remember, the Proposed Regulations say “in addition to.”32 The prohibition against appointing QTIP property to a third party is not violated by a power conferred by state law to allocate between income and principal to meet the duty of impartiality by adding a sentence to the end of Treas. Regs. §20.2056(b)-7(d)(1). Similar amendments are made with respect to gift tax marital deduction regulations. F. GST Regulations The GST regulations are amended to provide that the use of a unitrust or power to reallocate will not be considered to be a shift of a beneficial interest. G. Qualified Domestic Trust Under existing law, it is possible that the regulations would permit a unitrust (and perhaps even a trust permitting reallocation of principal under UPAIA §104) to qualify for QTIP treatment), but the QDT had additional problems because the §2056A regulations further provide as follows: 32 In an earlier version of this paper, I analyzed the existing regulations as follows: If the definition is other than the long standing common law approach, will that satisfy the federal requirements? The only way to answer that question is to analyze the exact language of the Treasury Regulations. In determining whether a beneficiary has the “right to income” Treas. Regs. §20.2056(b)-5(f)(1) provides that such test is met: ...[I]f the effect of the trust is to give her [sic] substantially that degree of beneficial enjoyment of the trust property during her life which the principles of the law of trusts afford to a person who is unqualifiedly designated as the life beneficiary of a trust. Such degree of enjoyment is given only if it was the decedent’s intention, as manifested by the terms of the trust instrument and surrounding circumstances, that the trust should produce for the 28 ACTEC Journal 140 (2002) In addition, income does not include any other item that would be allocated to corpus under applicable local law governing the administrations of trusts irrespective of any specific trust provision to the contrary. In cases where there is no specific statutory or case law regarding the allocation of such items under the law governing the administration of the QDOT, the allocation under this paragraph (c)(2) will be governed by general principles of law (including but not limited to any uniform state acts, such as the Uniform Principal and Income Act, or any Restatements of applicable law). Under this language, coupled with the specific reference to capital gains, it is doubtful that distributions from a unitrust in excess of the accounting income of the trust would be treated as income, at least absent a state law to the contrary. However, the proposed regulations make it clear that the rules regarding §104 allocations or a unitrust permitted by state law apply to QDTs as well as QTIPs. XIII. NON-UNITRUST ALTERNATIVES TO DEALING WITH ALL INCOME FORMULATIONS In the real world, many trusts measure distributions in term of income, whether such trusts were drafted because of a statutory requirement, because that was the wish of the testator or grantor, or because that was the way the draftsman always drafted them. While it will require legislation to deal with existing all income trusts, there are ways to allow the trustee to invest for total return either through the use of unitrusts, annuity trusts, “Give-Me-Five” trusts, or more conventional surviving spouse during her life such an income, or that the spouse should have such use of the trust property as is consistent with the trust corpus and with its preservation. Treas. Regs. §20.2056-5(b)(f)(2) makes it clear that the right to enjoyment may be given under the instrument as well as under state law. Almost seeming to anticipate section 104 of the UPAIA, Treas. Regs. §20.2056(b)-5(f)(4) state that the trustee’s power to allocate between income and principal will not run afoul of the right to income requirement if the powers are such that local courts would require the reasonable exercise thereof. From a review of the language of the existing regulations, it would be relatively easy to conclude that all of the formulae set forth below for unitrusts would meet the all income test. However, prudence dictates that one would not use them without either a private letter ruling or some published authority. And in this respect, the proposed regulations may actually narrow the ability to apply the all income trusts to unitrusts. techniques. Remember that the soapbox I am on is that the draftsman needs to spend more time helping the client focus on what he really wants, and then developing a distribution plan which allows the client to meet those desires. And as always, flexibility is the key. Thus, the issue at the private level is not whether an attorney ought to be drafting private unitrusts as a principal drafting approach. It is the overriding thesis of this paper that the most productive result of the unitrust debate will be to refocus attorneys on the need to better emphasize client desires in developing distribution provisions, and not the ascendancy of the unitrust as the first drafting preference. A. Solutions to the Statutorily Mandated All Income Trusts In those situations in which the settlor or testator is restricted by statute from designing the trust so that it precisely carries out his wishes, the amount of income can be controlled somewhat by the investment blend, and if there is a supplementary standard, the beneficiary can still enjoy distributions sufficient to provide for his or her needs. I do believe that an attempt to obliterate the distinction between income and principal will fail, as that concept is too deeply imbedded throughout the statutory and common law of trusts. In fact, UPAIA maintains this dichotomy, as will be discussed in greater detail below. 1. Discretionary Principal Distribution The trustee can be authorized to exercise discretion over principal for the benefit of the income beneficiary, and thereby protect the beneficiary while allowing the trustee to invest for total return. a. Total Discretion The discretion granted can be total discretion allowing the trustee to distribute “such amounts of principal as my trustee determines in its sole discretion.” The total discretion standard can also be used in a spray or sprinkle trust. Consideration should be given to a provision which would unequivocally state that the creator of the trust intends for the discretion to be absolute, and that no beneficiary may require a distribution. Should the trust contain factors for the trustee to consider in exercising its discretion? Some believe that this only creates problems, and that totally discretionary trusts should be totally discretionary. However, if the trust is drafted so that it is clear that the factors are only an expression of the settlor’s intent, and cannot be used as a basis for compelling distributions, then such expression may help the trustee in exercising its discretion. Obviously, the trustee cannot be a beneficiary of the trust under this standard. Equally obvious is that the trustee must exercise the discretion given, including a decision to make no distributions. Regardless of how broad the language of the trust is, the trustee must still exercise its discretion in a reasonable manner. Thorman v. Carr, 408 S.W.2d 259 (Tex. Civ App. [San Antonio] 1966). b. Best Interest Standard The discretion given the trustee may be a “best interest” standard; i.e., “the trustee may distribute such amounts of principal as it determines to be in the best interest of the beneficiary.” Again, this standard will work with a spray or sprinkle trust, but the trustee cannot be a beneficiary. If the best interest standard is to be used, the draftsman should specify whether a beneficiary can compel a distribution. If any guidance is given as to what the settlor envisioned would be in the best interest of the beneficiary, again the trust should be clear as to whether such guidelines can be used as a basis to compel a distribution. Since a fiduciary is always required to act in the best interest of the beneficiary, it is hard to see how this standard improves upon total discretion. I have determined that I will never use this standard in drafting. c. Subjective Standard As a middle ground, the trustee could be given discretion, with general guidelines that the trustee must consider. The beneficiary could use such standards in trying to convince a court that the trustee had abused its discretion and to compel a distribution. Again, the key is clarity in drafting. d. Objective Standard The discretion given the trustee may be an objective standard, such as “health, education, maintenance and support.” This standard is normally used when a beneficiary is a trustee. If there are multiple permissible distributees, then clear directions must be given as to preferences. In practice, these standards are seldom as objective as they seem, and almost always raise interpretation issues. 2. Formula Distributions Principal distributions can be made according to a preset formula, which could take into account the size of the income distribution by providing a fixed amount, so that the standard really becomes a “greater of” formula. The formula could also permit distributions in excess of the formula subject to a standard, or the formula could operate as a cap on distributions. A discussion of the various formulas is set out below in the unitrust drafting section. 3. Redefine Income State law may, of course, define income in any way the legislative body of the state chooses. For example, Texas Trust Code §113.101(a)(1) mandates the trustee to administer the trust with respect to the allocation of income and principal “in accordance with the terms of the instrument,” and in states which have adopted UPAIA there is even greater flexibility. Texas Trust Code §113.101(a)(2) provides that the Trust Code controls “in the absence of any contrary terms of the trust instrument.” Therefore, the creator of the trust is able to define what is income and what is principal. 28 ACTEC Journal 141 (2002) Of course, even under the proposed §643(b) regulations, if the instrument deviates from state law, it may run afoul of the federal tax rules. 4. Powers of Appointment The beneficiary can be given a power of appointment over principal. a. Special Power of Appointment The beneficiary could be given a special power of appointment which could be limited as to (i) time of exercise (i.e., either during life or at death, or both), (ii) amount, either by amount or percentage of the trust, and/or (iii) permissible appointees. In the latter case, the power could be as broad as possible (i.e.,to anyone other than the beneficiary, the beneficiary’s creditors, the beneficiary’s estate or the creditors of the beneficiary’s estate) or as narrow as desired (i.e., limited to one or more persons or classes such as descendants, charities, etc.). In any event, such a power would prevent inclusion in the estate for tax purposes. While such a power, whether exercised or not, would avoid inclusion of the trust in the beneficiary’s estate,33 an inter-vivos exercise of the power would create a gift of the income interest at the date of and to the extent of the exercise.34 Thus, an inter-vivos exercise of the power so as to appoint 10% of the principal will carry with it a gift of 10% of the income, which may or may not be subject to the annual exclusion depending upon the manner of exercise. A special testamentary power will still allow the trust to qualify for QTIP treatment if it meets the other tests under Code §2056(b)(7). b. General Power of Appointment The beneficiary may be given a general power of appointment which may also be limited as to time of exercise and the amount of the trust over which it may be exercised. This power will cause inclusion in the decedent’s estate of the property over which it may be exercised and will always constitute a gift of the entire interest transferred upon its intervivos exercise in favor of anyone other than the holder of the power or upon the lapse or release of the power in excess of 5% of the value of the trust. This type of power cannot be used in connection with a QTIP trust since the general power would cause the trust to be treated under Code §2056(b)(5). The general power may of course be limited to 5% of the value of the trust without its lapse or release causing a gift,35 but there will still be inclusion in the estate to the extent the power was exercisable at death. The 5% power will be discussed more fully below in dealing with the so called Give-Me-Five trust. B. Conventional Solutions Where All Income Is Not Mandated Even in cases in which all income is not mandated, there may be better solutions than the unitrust to allow the trustee to invest for total return. Again, the choice of this approach is based on the twin ideals of flexibility and drafting clarity. 1. Total Discretion Trusts The Trustee can be given total discretion as to income and principal. The considerations in drafting are the same as noted above. 2. Distributions According to Standard Distributions of principal and income could both be according to some standard. Once again, the considerations as to the use of standards for both income and principal are as set out above. 3. Formula Distributions It would seem obvious to me that where the law permits greater flexibility by not dictating the distribution of income, the draftsman should not create inflexibility by going to a unitrust approach. Therefore, any formula approach should be thought of as a minimum amount and be accompanied with some discretion in the trustee. In most cases, my approach would be to use no formula at all. 4. Powers of Appointment a. Special Powers of Appointment Special powers of appointment may be used as with all income trusts, but with no adverse gift tax implications. Since the beneficiary is not entitled to the income, an exercise of the special power will not result in a gift. b. General Power of Appointment The use of a general power of appointment is subject to the same considerations as with an all income trust. C. The Give-Me-Five Approach36 While under Mr. Horn’s own classification, the Give-Me-Five approach is a unitrust approach, and while it fits the definition of a unitrust posited in this article, I have chosen to present it separately from the other unitrust provisions since the Give-Me-Five 33 Code §2041(b)(1) limits a general power of appointment to one which can be exercised in favor of the decedent, his estate, his creditors or the creditors of his estate. 34 See Treas. Regs. §25.2511-1(e). 35 Code §2514(e). Note that this section specifically provides that a “lapse” of a power “shall be considered a release of such power.” 36 The comments and forms are taken from a presentation made by Jerold I. Horn at the Southwestern Legal Foundation 40th Annual Institute on Wills and Probate in May 2001. Mr. Horn’s paper was entitled “Total Return Trusts: Trusts That Do Not Distinguish Between Income and Principal.” See also, Horn, “Prudent Investor Rule, Modern Portfolio Theory,” and “Private Trusts: Drafting and Administration Under the ‘Give-Me-Five’ Unitrust,” 33 Real Property Probate & Trust Journal 26 (1998). 28 ACTEC Journal 142 (2002) approach is anything but a fixed distribution approach to drafting. What this approach does is give the beneficiary an annually lapsing general power of appointment to withdraw up to 5% of the value of the trust.37 It is presumed, although not required, that this power will be exercised by the donee in favor of the donee. To the extent the power is not exercised, the theory goes, the property stays within the trust, safe from transfer taxes and creditors. The efficacy of those theories is examined below. 1. Underlying Theories Mr. Horn has developed the Give-Me-Five approach based upon his belief that clients would always (or at least almost always) favor outright gifts, and it is the lawyer who injects the use of trusts for tax reasons, to provide asset and divorce protection, or control the ultimate devolution of the property. The latter reason is somewhat in conflict with the Give-MeFive approach. Since the client, under this theory, would have preferred just an outright gift, this technique is designed to approximate that as closely as possible in the trust context. 2. Use with All Income Trusts, et al. While this technique may be used as a stand alone standard for a non-marital trust, it may also be used as to principal in connection with an all income trust or a trust which distributes income according to a standard. Any exercise of the power in favor of a third party will result in a taxable gift. 3. Use as Marital Trust. Although the marital deduction all income requirement is usually couched in terms of distribution to the spouse, it is sufficient that the spouse have the right, exercisable at least annually, “to require distribution to herself of the trust income, and otherwise the trust income is to be accumulated and added to corpus.”38 Since the proposed regulations under §643(b) permit a 3%-5% unitrust to satisfy the all income requirement, it would seem that a 5% withdrawal right by the surviving spouse would meet the proposed regulatory test for both the testamentary general power of appointment trust under Code §2056(b)(5) and the QTIP provisions of Code §2056(b)(7) in those states which have a statute allowing the creation of unitrusts. 4. Flexibility and Easing of Tensions Give-Me-Five also provides tremendous flexibility (at least up to 5% of the value of the trust). Unlike mandated distribution trusts, there is no requirement that any of the property subject to the 5% power be distributed. And, unlike discretionary trusts, the determination as to whether to withdraw anything lies with the beneficiary and not the trustee. Thus, the trustee is not in conflict with the remainder interest since only the beneficiary holding the power can decide what to draw down. The conflict still exists where the trustee also can make discretionary distributions. See clause below. 5. A Sample Clause Following is a clause taken from the Southwestern Legal Foundation paper cited above. I have not changed the language utilized by the original draftsman as I did with Mr. Hoisington’s clauses below. This is the “omnibus” version the of the GiveMe-Five drafting approach in that it permits distribution in excess of 5% subject to a standard by a beneficiary/trustee and totally discretionary distributions by an independent trustee, even to the extent of terminating the trust. Obviously, the clause can be pared back by eliminating any of those additional powers. The clause is a fractional share clause, but a pecuniary clause could be used. Following the sample clause is a listing of the issues raised by this approach. a. Give-Me-Five. If, after attaining thirty years of age, the descendant is living immediately before the end of a calendar year, the Trustee shall pay to the descendant so much, if any, of the trust estate, not to exceed in value five percent of the value of the trust estate as of the end of the year, as the descendant last directs in writing before the end of the year. b. Additional Distributions. The Trustee shall pay to the descendant so much or all, if any, of the trust estate as the Trustee determines to be advisable from time to time, considering resources otherwise available, to provide for the descendant’s health, education and support in the manner of living to which accustomed. Additionally, The Trustee shall pay to the descendant so much or all, if any, of the balance of the trust estate as the Independent Trustee in its sole and absolute discretion determines to be advisable from time to time, considering or not considering resources otherwise available, for any purpose or reason whatsoever, including termination of the trust.39 6. Creditor Protection One of the stated purposes of the GiveMe-Five trust is creditor protection. Yet the law in many states, is unclear as to the effect this provision has with respect to creditors. For instance, prior to the lapse of the power, could a judge order a beneficiary to 37 This is really nothing more than the Crummey power in a different context. 38 Treas. Regs. §20.2056(b)-5(f)(8). 39 If the Trustee making the HEMS decisions is other than beneficiary, then how will the trustee know what to distribute if he has no idea what the beneficiary is going to withdraw until the end of the year? Even with respect to distributions under the total discretion standard, how much the beneficiary is going to withdraw still might affect the trustee’s decision. 28 ACTEC Journal 143 (2002) exercise this power for the benefit of creditors? As a corollary issue, in most states, spendthrift trust protection is not available for self-settled trusts. Does the lapse of the power cause the beneficiary to become the grantor of the trust to the extent of the lapse?40 7. Transfer Tax Avoidance The property subject to a general power of appointment will be included in the donee’s estate. Thus, one problem may be the inclusion of 5% of the trust in the gross estate of the donee. Mr. Horn would argue that the fact that the descendant must be alive at the end of the year would avoid inclusion in the estate. This, of course, presents some problems in the Trustee exercising its discretion since it has no way of knowing, in advance, how much the beneficiary will draw down, and obviously cannot make distribution of that amount prior immediately before the end of the year. 8. Income Tax and Grantor Trust Issues Code §678(a) treats the holder of the lapsed power as the grantor to the extent of the lapse. Further, it is the IRS position that the grantor status is cumulative, so that the donee of the power becomes the grantor of a greater portion of the trust each year.41 A detailed discussion of the income tax issues is beyond the scope of this paper, but suffice it to say that while Mr. Horn believes the problems are “solvable,” I remain less sure. That issue has never been raised by the IRS, but until it is resolved, there is a certain amount of risk in the Give-Me-Five formulation. Another issue that must be dealt with is who may choose the assets to be distributed if the Give-Me-Five power is exercised, the trustee or the beneficiary? And what is the effect on grantor trust status if the trustee is the beneficiary? 9. Assumes Financial Corpus As with the fixed return unitrust, the valuation issues are difficult to deal with if the assets of the trust are not primarily financial assets. also that some of these clauses are designed to be used to create supplemental benefits in addition to the primary benefits. These well thought out clauses are taken in large part from Mr. Hoisington’s article for the Heckerling Institute, cited above, with some modifications by the author.43 Most of these provisions employ averages rather than the current value in an attempt to reduce volatility in the amount distributed. Keep in mind that a discretionary trust, as noted earlier, is a form of unitrust. See the discussion above as to the various types of discretionary formulae. 1. Discretionary Distributions Not to Exceed Certain Percentage of Value Mr. Hoisington suggests that the following provision can be used as a supplement to a foregoing distribution formula such as all income or a fixed percentage. With slight modifications, such as raising the 2% cap to a larger number, it could also be used as a primary formula. Note that the beneficiary cannot be the trustee of this trust (at least as to distributions to himself or herself) and the spray or sprinkle provision must be removed if this provision is to be used in a QTIP trust. Additional distributions may be made to or for the benefit of the beneficiary and/or the descendants of the beneficiary in the discretion of the special trustee, but not in excess of 2% of the preceding 5 year end average fair market value of the trust property. In addition to the required distributions set out above, after the end of the first full calendar year during which the trust is funded (in whole or in part), the Trustee may, in its discretion, distribute to, or for the benefit of the Beneficiary and/or any of the then living descendants of the Beneficiary as much (if any) of the property in the Trust and in such manner, as the Trustee,44 may at any time determine and direct. The exercise of the trustee’s discretion, however, is limited as follows: XIV. SOME UNITRUST PROVISIONS A. Hoisington Provisions (as Modified by Golden)42 Following are some suggested clauses for implementing the unitrust design. Note that none of the provisions are the “greater of x% or all the income.” Note Some states have dealt with that issue by statute. See Texas Trust Code §112.035, which defines spendthrift trusts, and provides that the holder of a lapsed general power does not become a grantor as a result of the lapse. 41 See Priv. Ltr. Ruls. 200022035, 9034004, and 8701007. 42 Much of the material concerning the use of the private unitrust and its variations are based upon William L. Hoisington, Modern Trust Designs, ©1999 which was an update and expansion of his article for the Heckerling Institute, cited supra. 40 28 ACTEC Journal 144 (2002) The essence of our specialty is selective plagiarism with, of course, some modification to make such purloined material our own. While the type of formula is from Mr. Hoisington’s work, the author has taken the liberty, in some cases, of making substantial stylistic changes, which may even affect the substance. 44 Mr. Hoisington suggests that a special trustee may be used to make such distributions so that the trustee with investment and other distribution powers could be a beneficiary. 43 (1) The Trustee shall not make any discretionary distribution of trust property directly or indirectly to, or for the benefit of, the Trustee or in any circumstance in which such discretionary distribution would constitute a taxable gift by such Trustee; and, (2) The aggregate amount of any distributions made pursuant to this subparagraph during any one calendar year shall not exceed two percent of the average net fair market value of the trust property at the close of the last business day of each of the immediately preceding five calendar years or lesser number of years of the trust’s existence (excluding, in each case, any amounts that were required to be distributed during any preceding calendar year of the trust, but were not actually distributed prior to the end of the calendar year, and any residential real or tangible personal property held in the trust that was occupied by, or was within the possession or control of, the Beneficiary or any descendant of the Beneficiary at any time during the immediately preceding calendar year). Except to the extent that the Trustee may direct otherwise, distributions from the Trust to, or for the direct benefit of, any descendant of the Beneficiary shall be charged against the trust estate of the Trust as a whole and not against the ultimate distributive share (if any) of such descendant. Note that this provision does not provide the kind of certainty of distribution that the supporters of unitrusts advocate in that there is still a potential for disputes between the current beneficiaries and remaindermen, but it has the attribute of giving flexibility while still ostensibly preserving principal. Note, also, that this provision may require an allocation of GST exemption to the trust. The exclusions, which have been italicized, are extremely important. Note that there may be undistributed income in the trust on the valuation date which should not be included in determining value for the purpose of applying the unitrust percent. 2. Discretionary Distributions Not to Exceed Fixed (Inflation Adjusted) Amount This provision is also designed to be used as a supplement to a primary distribution formula. Used as a primary formula, it would be the annuity unitrust described below except for the discretionary feature. Because of the ascertainable standard, a beneficiary could also be the trustee. Additional amounts are required to be distributed for the beneficiary’s support if all financial resources available for the beneficiary’s support are insufficient, but not in excess of $50,000/year adjusted for inflation. If, at any time after the end of the first full calendar year during which the trust is in existence, the Trustee, in his good faith judgment, determines that the sum of (i) the amounts required to be distributed pursuant to subparagraphs [x.x.1] and [x.x.2] during the current calendar year and (ii) all other financial resources then available for the support of the Beneficiary that are reasonably quantifiable by the Trustee (such sum being referred to as the “Available Resources”) are insufficient in the aggregate to provide adequately for the Beneficiary’s reasonable support, the Trustee shall distribute to, or directly for the support of, the Beneficiary as much of the property then held in the Trust as, when added to the Available Resources of the Beneficiary, will, in the good faith judgment of the Trustee, provide adequately for the reasonable support of the Beneficiary; provided however that the aggregate amount of all distributions made pursuant to this subparagraph during any one calendar year of the trust (or portion thereof) shall not exceed the following described total amount (the Dollar Limit): The Dollar Limit for the first calendar year shall be Fifty Thousand Dollars ($50,000) increased or decreased by a percentage of such dollar amount as is equal to any percentage increase or decrease in consumer prices between January 1, 2000, and January 1 of the first calendar year during which the trust is funded (in whole or part); and the Dollar Limit for the next and each succeeding calendar year during which the trust is in existence shall be the Dollar Limit for 28 ACTEC Journal 145 (2002) the immediately preceding calendar year increased or decreased by a percentage of such dollar amount that is equal to the annual rate of change in consumer prices during the preceding calendar year determined as of the end of such preceding calendar year (yearover-year). For purposes of the foregoing changes in consumer prices shall be determined by reference to the Consumer Price Index for All Urban Consumers (CPI-U), not seasonally adjusted, or any other independently maintained cost of living index that the Trustee determines in good faith more accurately reflects the costs of living of the Beneficiary during such preceding calendar year. This provision could also be accompanied with a cap on total distributions from principal based upon the amount of income received by the beneficiary. Provisions of this nature dealing with “Available Resources” are difficult to draft. While I believe this one is relatively clear in that includes capital as well as income, does this mean that the beneficiary must sell his or her home or ranch before getting anything from the trust? I think not, but a court may see things differently. 3. The Fixed Percent of Market Value This formula is designed to be used as a primary formula, and the beneficiary can serve as trustee. This is nothing more than the charitable unitrust formula without a congressionally mandated amount. Some of the practical problems in the use of this formula can be seen in the clause below and in the New York statute. in the Beneficiary’s Family Trust on the last business day of each of the immediately preceding five calendar years or lesser number of years of the trust’s existence; provided however that, in the case of a short year, the Trustee shall prorate the aggregate annual amount on a daily basis. Within a reasonable time after the end of each calendar year, the Trustee shall pay to the Beneficiary (in the case of an underpayment) or receive from the Beneficiary (in the case of an overpayment), without interest (in either case), the difference between any amounts actually paid during the preceding calendar year and the aggregate amount required to be paid during that year. Solely for purposes of determining the annual amount that is required to be distributed to the Beneficiary pursuant to this subparagraph [x.x.1], “net fair market value of all property held in the Beneficiary’s Family Trust” shall exclude any amounts that were required to be distributed during any preceding calendar year of the trust, but were not actually distributed prior to the end of the calendar year, and shall not include the fair market value of any residential real or tangible personal property held in the trust that was occupied or possessed by, or the occupancy or possession of which was within the control of, the Beneficiary (other than merely in their capacity as the Trustee of the trust) at any time during the calendar year of the trust. 4% of the value of trust is distributed to or for the support of the beneficiary annually. The Trustee shall distribute to, or as directed by, or directly for the support of, the Beneficiary, at convenient intervals, but at least annually, amounts in the aggregate equal to four percent of the net fair market value of all property held in the Trust at the close of the last business day of the year45 during which the Trust was first established and, thereafter, four percent of the average net fair market value of all property held Studies by David Levine and Roger Hertog indicate that the real value of the trust can probably be sustained, but barely, with a 3% distribution requirement, and that a 5% distribution requirement would result in a substantial reduction in real value of the portfolio and resultant reduction in real value of the income distributions. Even today, there is no agreement as to whether 4% (the New York amount) is too high. So long as the growth rate exceeds the inflation rate, everyone ought to be relatively happy campers. However, if the inflation rate suddenly outpaces growth and Note that Mr. Hoisington uses a five-year rolling average as opposed to the three-year rolling average utilized by Mr. Wolf. Studies would indicate that the five-year period adds little additional smoothing, and the three-year period would seem preferable. 45 28 ACTEC Journal 146 (2002) the unitrust rate, then the real value of the income beneficiary’s distributions will drop. A large drop well into the term of the trust, after the beneficiary has established a lifestyle based on the distributions could prove disastrous. It is of course possible that the distributions would drop in nominal terms also. 4. Indexed Annuity This is the charitable annuity trust formula, but indexed for inflation. It is designed to assure that the beneficiary always has a fixed amount in terms of inflation adjusted dollars. One of the more interesting features is that the trust is designed to substantially increase its distributions after reaching a certain age. This may answer the concern often expressed by clients today that they do not want their children to receive so much from the trust that the incentive to be productive is diminished. Note the inflexibility of this, and the fixed percent of value formulae, if there are no discretionary distributions in addition to these amounts. Also note that this is a cap based on the value of the trust, in case the distributions deplete the value of the trust. The beneficiary can be the trustee under this formula. $48,000 is distributed to or for the support of the beneficiary annually as long as the beneficiary is living and under the age of 60 and $96,000 after 60. The Trustee shall distribute to, or as directed by, or directly for the support of, the Beneficiary, at convenient intervals, but at least annually, amounts in the aggregate equal to the Annuity Amount as hereinafter determined. The Annuity Amount for the first calendar year during which the Trustee is satisfied that the trust is substantially fully funded shall be $48,000 if and while the Beneficiary is living and under the age of 60 years and $96,000 if and while the Beneficiary is living and over the age of 60 years, in either case, increased by a percentage of such dollar amount that is equal to any percentage increase in consumer prices between January 1, 2000, and January 1 of the first calendar year during which the trust is funded (in whole or part). The Annuity Amount for the next and each succeeding calendar year during which the trust is in existence shall be the Annuity Amount for the immediately preceding calendar year increased or decreased by a percentage of such dollar amount that is equal to the average annual rate of change in consumer prices during the preceding five calendar years determined as of the end of each such preceding calendar year. For purposes of the foregoing, changes in consumer prices shall be determined by reference to the Consumer Price Index for All Urban Consumers (CPI-U), not seasonally adjusted, or any other independently maintained cost of living index that the Trustee determines in good faith more accurately reflects the costs of living of the Beneficiary during such preceding calendar year. Notwithstanding anything in the foregoing to the contrary, in no event shall the Annuity Amount exceed five percent of the net fair market value of all property held in this trust at the close of the last business day of each of the immediately preceding five calendar years or lesser number of years of the trust’s existence, excluding, in each case, any amounts that were required to be distributed during any preceding calendar year of the trust, but were not actually distributed prior to the end of the calendar year, and further excluding the fair market value of any residential real or tangible personal property held in the trust that was occupied or possessed by, or the occupancy or possession of which was within the control of, the Beneficiary (other than merely in their capacity as the Trustee of the trust) at any time during the calendar year of the trust. 5. Market Performance Unitrust This type of unitrust formula was developed by James P. Garland. The theory behind this is that tying distributions to value is a very artificial measurement, and that distributions should be tied to market returns. The beneficiary can be the trustee under this provision. Distributions are sum of 125% of dividends plus bond yields and 4% of other assets held for investment. While Beneficiary is living, the Trustee shall, each calendar year, distribute to Beneficiary an amount or amounts in the aggregate equal to the following: (a) The product of [i] 125% of the average dividend yield on the S&P 28 ACTEC Journal 147 (2002) 500 Stock Index for the immediately preceding 5 calendar years and [ii] the average fair market value on the last business day of each of the immediately preceding 5 calendar years (or lesser number of years of the trust’s existence) of that portion of the trust investments that consists of publicly traded equity securities, plus (b) the actual yield on the portion of the trust property that is invested in bonds or other debt instruments, less any percentage increase (or plus any percentage decrease) in consumer prices during the immediately preceding calendar year (year-over-year), as reflected in any change in the Consumer Price Index for All Urban Consumers (CPI-U), not seasonally adjusted, plus (c) 4% of the market value at the end of the preceding calendar year of all other trust property that is held primarily for investment, which shall not include the fair market value of any residential real or tangible personal property held in the trust that was occupied or possessed by, or the occupancy or possession of which was within the control of, the Beneficiary (other than merely in their capacity as the Trustee of the trust) at any time during the calendar year of the trust. Mr. Hoisington suggests, although Mr. Garland would probably not agree, that the formula was developed at a time when dividends were a good deal higher in relation to value, and that clause (a) should be permanently modified to something such as 150% of the average earnings on S&P 500 stocks. Of course, this assumes that dividend policies will remain constant. This assumption may or may not be valid. In fact, as Mr. Garland points out, if stock values decline, then, in all probability, the amount of dividends will increase in relation to the value of the stock and therefore in relation to earnings also. Clause (c) causes some problems also in that if the assets held for investment but are neither publicly traded securities nor bonds, then valuation becomes a problem. If you use this type of formula, there must be some provision made, either here or in the administrative provisions as to how the valuation of these difficult to value assets is to be done. This is, 28 ACTEC Journal 148 (2002) of course, a problem in any percentage of value distribution formula. B. The Northern Trust Forms Northern Trust Co. has prepared forms creating a fixed payout unitrust and an annuity type trust. I believe that these forms are exceptionally well thought out, and deal with the issues of hard to value assets much better than the New York statute. Northern Trust notes in its comments that a unitrust (whether fixed percent or annuity type) should not be used where the trust has large non-financial and difficult to value assets. Copies of the proposed Northern Trust forms are posted on the private side of the ACTEC Web site as Appendices A-1 and A-2. XV. CONCLUSION Drawing a conclusion about the various approaches and the multi-faceted and complex arguments is very difficult and goes to the heart of what an estate planner does. A. The Economic Conclusions The economic arguments center largely around belief in future performance and whether the past is indeed prologue to the future. The arguments certainly prove that statistics can be used to prove almost any proposition. Almost all agree that higher returns in the present inevitably produce lower returns in the future, and vice versa. David Levine argues that, “[Fixed percentage of value] Unitrusts represent the classic error of ‘fighting the last war.’” I am not persuaded by the advocates of the fixed percent of value unitrust, primarily because of the lack of flexibility. Additionally, this type of trust spends a great deal of appreciation in the early years and discriminates heavily in favor of the income beneficiary. B. Fixing Existing Trusts Each of the statutory solutions to adapting existing trusts to the prudent investor standard is flawed. The unitrust model is simply too inflexible. Even if all beneficiaries agree, a beneficiary could potentially claim that all of the facts were not explained. UPAIA §104 cannot be used with a beneficiary/trustee. In some situations, perhaps, a modification could be sought to allow the appointment of an independent trustee to make the §104 allocations. C. The Drafting Conclusions One of the more interesting aspects of this discussion is that the two lawyers involved believe passionately in unitrusts, one economist (Garland) also believes in unitrusts, but only those related to returns, not value. And Messrs. Levine, Collins, et al., the economists, believe that the all income trust works just fine. So what is the estate planner to do with all these decisions? • First, remember that this is not new. • Second, the main goal is still to accomplish the client’s objectives, particularly with respect to current beneficiaries. While the generation skipping transfer tax causes many people to set up dynasty trusts, there are also strong non-tax reasons that apply only to spouse and children. Most of my clients are not really concerned beyond that. (And special powers of appointment allow children to deal with their descendants.) • Third, depending upon the trustee, a totally discretionary trust or a trust with standards that apply to both income and principal allow the trustee to invest for overall return. Even an all income trust that allows principal invasion should not limit the trustee’s investment power. And if there is any doubt, the draftsman can clearly state that the trustee can invest for overall return in accordance with modern portfolio theory, and then gild the lily by incorporating the prudent investor rule as the investment standard. If an ascertainable standard is used, the draftsman must make it clear as to how the income beneficiary is to be treated and whether the trustee is to be relieved of the duty of impartiality. • Fourth, the choice of trustee is critical. In a long term “happy” marriage, the choice of the surviving spouse probably will get the testator where he or she wants to be—leave all the money at the disposal of the spouse. This may also be true with a trust for a responsible child where the child is the trustee. In situations of a second marriage, perhaps the only way to get the proper spending result is an independent trustee or a fixed return unitrust. • Fifth, if the testator desires to prefer one beneficiary, then that should be spelled out also. • Sixth, if the testator desires to assure a real fixed level of spending, then an annuity approach may work, but a choice of the level must be carefully considered since a sharp and prolonged downturn could substantially deplete the trust. D. The Bottom Line When I first started reading in this area, I was convinced that the fixed percentage of value unitrust was the wave of the future and the way future trusts should be drafted. However, after much consideration, I am convinced that more attention to the client’s spending desires and more careful statements in the trust as to intent produce a better result. The question I could not escape is, “If the ‘experts’ cannot agree on the proper formula, how can I lead a client into this morass?” In other words, the unitrust concept is a solution in search of a problem, but the discussion surrounding it has exposed some things on which we, as estate planners, should focus more carefully. 28 ACTEC Journal 149 (2002) Washington Report by John M. Bixler and Ronald D. Aucutt Washington, D.C. The anticipated Senate vote on permanent repeal of the estate tax occurred on June 12. It required 60 votes to pass, and the vote was 54-44. Therefore, to the surprise of no one, the measure failed. Before voting on permanent repeal, the Senate took up alternatives offered by Democratic senators, including accelerated increases in the unified credit (which failed by a vote of 38-60) and expansion of qualified family-owned business interest (QFOBI) relief (which failed by a vote of 44-54). The Republican leadership vowed to continue the repeal effort at another time. Election Prospects It is widely believed that the 2002 congressional elections will produce little change. In the House of Representatives, almost all incumbents’ seats are safe, some made more so by recent friendly redistricting. Whichever party holds control of the House in the 108th Congress (2003-04), control will probably continue to be by a razor-thin margin. And no one needs to be reminded of how fragile control of the Senate is. Given that a majority of the members of both the House and the Senate, as well as the President, have expressed support this year for making the repeal of the estate tax permanent (albeit in the year 2010), one might wonder how long, in a democracy, that expressed will of the majority can be suppressed. It is easy to imagine that if the Democrats regain control of the House and retain control of the Senate, they will consider trying to roll back some of the 2001 tax cuts, including the repeal of the estate tax. But they would probably have trouble undoing the majorities that favor estate tax repeal, especially the somewhat bipartisan majority in the House, and in any event any attempt to roll back repeal would meet with a veto from President Bush. The more interesting scenario to envision is what to expect if the Republicans regain control of the Senate and keep control of the House. The way votes on the estate tax are currently balanced, especially in the Senate, the biggest effect of control will not be the votes it brings, it will be the ability to control the agenda. In the Senate, there is always the possibility of a filibuster, which requires 60 votes to break, but that possibility is often diluted by strategic mixing of popular and controversial items in the same bill. In general, though, only the party that controls the Senate has the ability to do that. 28 ACTEC Journal 150 (2002) Legislative Agenda The election year of 2002 has not been very productive of tax legislation. Congress left medical and long-term care relief, military tax relief, pension legislation, energy tax legislation, the charity/“faith based initiative” proposals (about which we were optimistic in the summer issue), the trade bill, tax shelter legislation, corporate “inversion” legislation, investor tax relief, and any measures dealing with the foreign sales corporations (FSCs) to be carried over to the 108th Congress in 2003, or a late-2002 lame duck session of the 107th Congress. A lame duck session is expected in mid-November, to deal with “continuing resolutions” to keep the government funded and homeland security legislation, which the White House regards as a high priority. Such a session could be interesting. Control of the Senate is so fragile that if former Republican Congressman Jim Talent defeats Sen. Jean Carnahan in their close Senate race in Missouri, Republicans will immediately regain control of the Senate for any lame duck session in 2002. That is because Sen. Carnahan is an appointed Senator (to take the seat of her deceased husband, whose name was on the 2000 ballot), the 2002 election is therefore a special election to fill a vacancy, and the results will be given effect immediately. Meanwhile, a Senator to take the seat of Democratic Sen. Paul Wellstone for the rest of 2002 may be appointed by the quixotic governor of Minnesota, Jesse Ventura. Legislative prospects—short-term and long-term— are just impossible to predict. Two generalizations seem reasonably safe (which means they might be the first things we have to take back in 2003). The first is that even a “permanent” repeal of the estate tax, if it occurs, is unlikely to be effective before 2010, providing ample opportunity for future Congresses and Administrations to reconsider it. The second is that fundamental tax reform, which many view as an alternative to total repeal sometime this decade, is very unlikely in 2003, while an uncertain economy and a military and homeland security buildup combine to deny Congress the budget surpluses that once were promised. That aspiration still seems to be on a trajectory to begin to make progress no earlier than 2005, at the beginning of either President Bush’s second term or a new Administration. Administrative Developments in the Works Meanwhile, the “business plan”—the 2002-2003 Priority Guidance Plan released by Treasury and the Internal Revenue Service in early July—sets forth 250 projects to be completed during the twelve-month period from July 2002 through June 2003. Twelve of these projects are listed under the heading of “Gifts, Estates and Trusts”: 1. Final regulations under section 643 regarding state law definition of income for trust purposes. (Proposed regulations (REG-106513-00) were issued in February 2001. As we elaborated in the summer issue, we are interested in the degree to which these regulations will address all tax issues—income tax, gift tax, and GST tax—and the degree to which they will recognize the autonomy of state legislatures and courts without prescribing federal standards.) 2. Final regulations under section 645 regarding an election by certain revocable trusts to be treated as part of the associated estate. (Proposed regulations (REG-106542-98) were issued in December 2000. The final regulations should be close to issuance.) 3. Update revenue procedures under section 664 containing sample charitable remainder annuity trust provisions. 4. Update revenue procedures under section 664 containing sample charitable remainder unitrust provisions. 5. Guidance under section 664 regarding capital gains for charitable remainder trusts. 6. Final regulations under section 671 regarding reporting requirements for widely held fixed investment trusts. (The IRS issued proposed regulations on June 19 (REG-106871-00), replacing proposed regulations that had been issued in 1998. Widely held fixed investment trusts are most likely to arise in investment and commercial, not estate planning, contexts.) 7. Guidance under sections 671 and 2036 regarding tax reimbursement provisions in grantor trusts. (This recalls the intensely controversial observation of the Service in Letter Ruling 9444033 (Aug. 5, 1994), dealing with two GRATs, that “[i]f there were no reimbursement provision, an additional gift to a remainderperson would occur when the grantor paid tax on any income that would otherwise be payable from the corpus of the trust.” After a firestorm of protest, the ruling was reissued a year later with that provision deleted. Letter Ruling 9543049 (Aug. 3, 1995).) 8. Guidance under sections 2033 and 2039 regarding New York City and New York State Accidental Death Benefits. 9. Final regulations under sections 2055 and 2522 based on the Boeshore decision. (Estate of Boeshore v. Commissioner, 78 T.C. 523 (1982), acq. in result, 1987-1 C.B. 1, invalidated the rule in the regulations that prohibited a deduction for a charitable lead interest if there was a preceding or concurrent non- charitable lead interest. Proposed amendments to the regulations issued on July 22 (REG-115781-01) provide an exception to that prohibition where the noncharitable lead interest, like the charitable lead interest, is in the form of an annuity or unitrust interest. 10. Regulations under section 2519 regarding net gifts. (Proposed amendments issued on July 19 (REG123345-01) fill in heretofore “reserved” portions of the regulations, to provide that the donee’s obligation under section 2207A(b) to pay the gift tax on a spouse’s section 2519 disposition of a QTIP interest is subtracted, in “net gift” fashion, in computing the amount of the gift, and also that the spouse’s failure to exercise that right of recovery constitutes an additional taxable gift. In due course, the IRS cancelled the public hearing on these regulations, because no one had asked to testify, implying that these regulations might be finalized without significant changes. 11. Guidance under section 2642 regarding issues relating to the generation-skipping transfer tax exemption. (This guidance will address the new rules related to allocation of GST exemption, enacted in the Economic Growth and Tax Relief Reconciliation Act of 2001.) 12. Guidance under section 2702 providing model qualified personal residence trust provisions. Exempt Organizations The following projects appear on the business plan under the heading of “Exempt Organizations”: 1. Guidance on joint ventures between exempt organizations and for-profit companies. (This guidance will presumably build on the “good” and “bad” examples in Rev. Rul. 98-15, 1998-1 C.B. 718, possibly including joint ventures in contexts other than health care, joint ventures based merely on simple contracts rather than separate entities, and joint ventures involving a commitment of less than all of the exempt organization’s assets.) 2. Guidance on section 501(c)(4) organizations. 3. Guidance under section 501(c)(12). 4. Guidance on private foundation terminations. (Rev. Rul. 2002-28, 2002-20 I.R.B. 941, addressed the common scenarios of a split-up of a private foundation into two or more private foundations, the incorporation of a private foundation that had been a charitable trust, and the merger of two private foundations. The clarifications in Rev. Rul. 2002-28 will eliminate the need to file individual ruling requests in many cases. It is not clear what issues any further guidance might address.) 5. Guidance on the application of existing UBIT rules to the Internet activities of exempt organizations. 6. Regulations under section 529 regarding qualified tuition programs. 7. Guidance on split interest trusts. 28 ACTEC Journal 151 (2002) S Corporations The following projects appear on the business plan under the heading of “Subchapter S”: 1. Final regulations under section 1361 regarding the time for beneficiary to make a QSST election. 2. Guidance under section 1362 regarding ESOP rollover to IRA. 3. Guidance under section 1362 regarding late S corporation election. 4. Guidance under section 1367 regarding the basis of S corporation stock held by ESOP. Split-Dollar Life Insurance Arrangements “Guidance regarding split-dollar life insurance” appears on the business plan under the heading of “Insurance Companies and Products.” This closely watched project revolves around proposed regulations that were issued on July 9, 2002 (REG-164754-01, 67 Fed. Reg. 45414), following Notice 2002-8, 2002-4 I.R.B. 398. As of press time, the most recent public development was the issuance of Notice 2002-59, expressing IRS and Treasury disapproval of the use of “high” P.S. 58 or Table 2001 premium rates to justify inflated payments by senior-generation insured persons in “reverse split-dollar” contexts to transfer wealth (non-insurance economic benefits) to younger generations. Notice 2002-59 (in section 3.01) pronounces what amounts to a death sentence: “The use of such techniques by any party to understate the value of these other policy benefits distorts the income, employment, or gift tax consequences of the arrangement and does not conform to, and is not permitted by, any published guidance.” Even apart from Notice 2002-59, the effectiveness of such techniques was poignantly questioned by ACTEC Fellow Howard Zaritsky, who was quoted in Steve Leimberg’s Estate Planning Newsletter as skeptically musing: “I voluntarily overpay for something, give up the asset to a family member, and then assert that it is not a gift?” We think Howard has a point. Personnel Changes Pamela F. Olson was sworn in on September 26 as the new Assistant Secretary of the Treasury for Tax Policy, a position she has filled on an “acting” basis since Mark Weinberger left Treasury in April 2002 to rejoin Ernst & Young LLP. In her statement to the Finance Committee, Assistant Secretary Olson appeared to affirm the commitment frequently identified with IRS Chief Counsel B. John Williams to concentrate enforcement resources on “tax shelters”—that is, “bad actors”—not necessarily routine controversies. Her exact words were: “Working together with former Assistant Secretary Mark Weinberger, Commissioner 28 ACTEC Journal 152 (2002) Rossotti, and Chief Counsel B. John Williams, we have endeavored to resolve and remove from contention other issues—issues more appropriately resolved with published guidance—that absorb too many Internal Revenue Service enforcement resources and distract from far more significant compliance issues.” It is tempting to suppose that many routine estate and gift tax controversies—notably valuation disputes—might disappear from the IRS radar screen under this approach, and there is some anecdotal indication from IRS examiners and counsel in the field that they might be observing, or at least perceiving, such a shift. There is cause to wonder, however, how valuation disputes could effectively be addressed by “published guidance.” A “tax shelter” approach, if it is not handled with sensitivity to the uniqueness of the estate planning context, could produce mischief by categorizing assets and transactions with reference to broadbrush “objective” criteria that produce inappropriate results. Such a remedy might well prove to be worse than the malady. (Nothing about valuation appears on the 2002-2003 business plan.) Significantly, Assistant Secretary Olson was asked in the Finance Committee hearing if, in light of the recent Senate vote, Treasury would consider supporting estate tax relief short of complete repeal, particularly for farmers and family-owned businesses. Her response affirmed the Bush Administration’s commitment to total repeal. Catherine Veihmeyer Hughes, an ACTEC Fellow and our former partner, has recently joined Treasury to work on estate and gift tax issues. Noting Cathy’s ACTEC and bar association experience, Treasury’s August 12 press release quoted Acting Assistant Secretary Pam Olson as saying that “Treasury is extremely fortunate to have someone of her caliber join the Office of Tax Policy.” We agree. Heather C. Maloy has moved from the IRS Chief Counsel’s Income Tax & Accounting Division to become Associate Chief Counsel (Passthroughs & Special Industries), with overall responsibility for the division that issues rulings and writes regulations and other guidance relating to the estate, gift, and GST taxes, the income taxation of estates and trusts and their beneficiaries, and the tax treatment of partnerships and S corporations. She succeeds Paul Kugler, who retired from the Service after a distinguished career, in which he earned great respect both in and out of the Service for his even-handed decision-making and his knowledge of the subject matter under his oversight, especially partnerships. Ms. Maloy’s name will be less familiar to most estate planners at first, but there are ample reports, from both inside and outside the Service, of good experiences with matters in which she has been involved. Foundation News by John A. Wallace Atlanta, Georgia The Board of Directors of the ACTEC Foundation met on June 27, 2002 in New York City in conjunction with the summer meeting of the College. This was my first meeting as President, and our first order of business was to express our appreciation to Norm Benford for his leadership as President of the Board of Directors of the Foundation for the past three years. Norm did a splendid job on our behalf during this time period. The next order of business was to welcome Professor Mark L. Ascher, an Academic Fellow at the University of Texas School of Law, to the Board; he was immediately appointed to the Grant Committee, which continues to be chaired by Professor Jeffrey N. Pennell, a faculty member of the School of Law at Emory University. Mark will add considerably to our grantmaking deliberations. There has been a substantial degree of grant-making activity of the part of the Foundation over the past year, with approximately $160,000 of grants payable currently outstanding. The Foundation remains solvent with between $400,000 and $500,000 of assets on hand, but we are spending down the principal of the Foundation rapidly because annual contributions in recent years have only averaged between $40,000 and $50,000 annually. Most importantly, we are busy implementing a $100,000 grant to finance yet another law program through a one-hour television special to be broadcast over the PBS network as a part of the Inside the Law series. This latest program will be entitled “Financial Planning for Incapacity.” This follows on the heels of the one-hour special entitled “Are you Prepared for Death,” which like the inaugural program was by all accounts a great success in terms of distribution through local PBS stations around the country. The “Are You Prepared for Death” program was a product of a steering committee composed of Jack Lombard, Sara Stadler, Frank Collin, Gerry Cowan and Donna Barwick. The new program covering incapacity issues will be formulated through a steering committee composed of Frank Reiche, Jim Wade, Susan House, Judy McCue and Bob Chapin. We owe this hardworking committee our thanks for their work on this program, which should be available early next year. We will be asking the Fellows to assist us in encouraging their local PBS stations to air this program in their cities and states. We will be preparing a talking piece for you and you will be hearing from us in that regard. Your efforts in the past for both the “Are You Prepared for Death?” and “Death and Taxes” in encouraging your local PBS stations to air our programs has been quite effective, and we expect to call on you again this time around. “Financial Planning for Incapacity” will address various property law and social considerations in planning for disability and will include discussions of revocable trusts, guardianships and durable powers of attorney. We hope that the educational outcome from this program will assist all of us encountering the frustration of dealing with institutions that still attempt to thwart appropriate uses of, say, durable powers of attorney when a client becomes incapacitated. We expect that educating the public and those connected with financial institutions around the country will be very useful in helping to recognize the use of durable powers of attorney for our clients going forward. Further to this point, the Foundation has made funds available to underwrite the costs of a study on the use and misuse of powers of attorney, again with a view toward assisting the appropriate use of durable powers. The Elder Law Committee of the College has been helping coordinate this study, and we look forward to the results with great anticipation. Moreover, the Board approved a $10,000 grant to The University of Miami School of Law to support scholarships for its Graduate Tax Program in Estate Planning attendees. This one-year program is unique, and the Board felt that it should be supported by the Foundation with the hope that the success of this program might cause comparable programs to be established in other law schools around the country. This type of activity attempts to fulfill one of the primary goals of the Foundation, which is to help convince lawyers and law school programs to support the fields of law in which we have an interest. Finally, the Directors spent a considerable amount of time discussing the fund raising experience of the Foundation since its inception. Several special events have been quite successful in raising funds for the activities of the Foundation in the past, but in those years when we limited our appeal for support to asking the Fellows that they include the Foundation in their charitable giving plans, we have met with less than optimal results. As noted earlier, we usually receive between $40,000 and $50,000 a year from this appeal, and we have a number of Fellows who have supported the Foundation in this manner faithfully and substantially. The unfortunate news is that we typical- 28 ACTEC Journal 153 (2002) ly number only around 10% of our membership in the donor category each year. Frankly, this is disappointing to the Directors, and we feel that a yield of this sort must result from a failure on our part (or perhaps our broader leadership group) to educate the Fellows about the activities of the Foundation and the contributions that it makes toward educating the public in the areas of our fields of practice and also with respect to important decisions that many people either ignore 28 ACTEC Journal 154 (2002) or refuse to address. Our case to you must clearly be made with greater impact, something that we will attempt to achieve well before charitable giving time this year. Meanwhile, we encourage you to be on the lookout for our efforts in this regard, and to be generous in your support of our programming and the activities of the Foundation when you have the opportunity to consider your personal charitable giving decisions this year. Spotlight On Attorneys’ Fees compiled by Martin A. Heckscher Philadelphia, Pennsylvania This report, which is a regular feature of ACTEC Journal, focuses on significant recent court decisions and rules, legislative enactments and IRS developments bearing on attorney compensation in the trust and estate practice. The report is heavily dependent on the willingness of all the Fellows to furnish material that they think would be suitable for inclusion. Please send Spotlight’s compiling editor a brief write-up (as little as one paragraph will do) about a recent case, rule, statute or ruling which you believe is either important in the jurisdiction in question or of widespread interest. In addition, the Surrogate found that the attorneys’ second trip to the court to “examine original file” for which they billed $1,625 was an unnecessary and unreasonable expense to the trust. The court found the reasonable attorneys’ fee to be $12,187.50 including disbursements and directed the attorneys to refund $7,812.50 to the trust. Wright v. Bankers Trust Hudson Valley, N.A, (N.Y.L.J. June 8, 2002, at 26, Dutchess Co. Surrogate Pagones). OHIO Jeffry L. Weiler, Cleveland NEW YORK Sanford J. Schlesinger, New York City Attorneys’ Fee for Trust Accounting Preparation Services Disallowed; Fee Based on Retainer Agreement Substantially Reduced The corporate trustee of an inter vivos trust filed a judicial accounting covering twenty years of trust administration and sought approval of $40,000 in attorneys’ fees, half of which had already been paid. After the parties waived a hearing the Surrogate’s Court decided the issues on the papers. The trust provided that the trustee may employ counsel and agents and pay them reasonable compensation. At the outset the court found that the hourly rates for two partners ($295 to $325) and for associates and paralegals at the trustee’s law firm were not excessive, although it pointed out that the rates were substantially higher than the average in the geographical area. The court noted, however, that more than half the recorded time was attributed to “review of transaction statements” and “account preparation.” The trustee had agreed to a flat fee of $40,000 based on the “size and complexity of the trust.” The court stated that it “bears the ultimate responsibility to decide what constitutes reasonable legal compensation,” even when there is a specific retainer agreement between the parties, and that “it is appropriate for the Surrogate to cut a requested fee when it appears that executory services were performed by an attorney.” The court observed that it was apparent that a substantial portion of the non-legal accounting services, which are the trustee’s responsibility, were performed instead by the attorneys as part of their “flat-fee” arrangement. The Surrogate held that “under the circumstances, I do not find that it is appropriate for those services to be billed to the trust.” Fee for Attorney Serving as Attorney and Executor Cannot Be Based Solely on Schedule in Local Court Rule Attorney Kammer served as the executor and attorney for decedent’s estate. Kammer applied to the probate court for his executor’s and attorney’s fees. The beneficiaries of the estate consented to the fees requested. The probate court allowed the statutory executor fee but reduced the attorney’s fee by 50 percent based on the formula established by local court rule, which provides that an attorney serving as both executor and attorney for an estate is entitled to onehalf of his attorney’s fee if he receives a full executor’s fee. The Court of Appeals held that the probate court improperly applied the formula provided in the rule without an evidentiary hearing to determine the reasonableness of the attorney’s fee based on the value of the services rendered. The court cited three Ohio cases holding that the probate court may not arbitrarily award an attorney’s fee based on a fee schedule but must exercise its discretion to determine the fee when the attorney serves in dual capacities. Accordingly, the court remanded the matter for a hearing to determine the fee. In re Estate of Rothert, 2002 WL 834509 (Ohio Ct. App., May 3, 2002). TEXAS Gerry W. Beyer, San Antonio Compiling Editor’s Note: Although the following case dealt with several questions about attorneys’ fees in litigation involving an estate and a testamentary trust, the writeup does not focus on the attorneys’ fees. Instead our focus is on the court’s principal holding 28 ACTEC Journal 155 (2002) which substantially reduced an executor’s commission, an issue not usually covered in Spotlight. Your editor believes that the court’s reasoning in this case for increasing the surcharge for an excessive executor’s commission is important because it may apply by analogy in substantial estates where a surcharge for an excessive fee payable to an executor’s attorney is at issue. Surcharge for Excessive Executor’s Commission May Not Be Reduced by Estate Tax Savings That Would Have Resulted If Full Commission Were Allowed and Deducted; Trustee of Testamentary Trust Removed for Breach of Fiduciary Duty Required to Reimburse Trust for Beneficiary’s Attorneys’ Litigation Fees Plus Interest In Lee v. Lee, 47 S.W. 3rd 767 (Tex. App. Houston [14th Dist.] 2001, pet. denied), decedent left the bulk of her estate to testamentary trusts for her son, daughter and grandchildren and named her son executor of the estate and trustee of the trusts. Because of valuation, tax, liquidity, and related issues, it took about eight years before the son began to fund the trusts and make distributions. During that time the son paid himself over $2.8 million for his executor’s commission. The daughter objected, claiming that the commission was excessive. After a jury determined that the commission was unreasonable by approximately $2.2 million, the trial court reduced the surcharge by $660,000 by giving credit for the tax saving realized by deducting the disallowed portion of the commission on the federal estate tax return. On appeal the daughter asserted that it would be unjust to permit her brother to retain $1.5 million of his excessive commission because the increased deduction would reduce the federal estate tax. The Court of Appeals first addressed the possible application of § 241 of the Texas Probate Code which permits the court to deny the commission allowed by statute if the executor does not manage the estate prudently. Because settlor’s will directed that the son shall receive just and reasonable compensation, the court concluded that § 241 could not apply. Next, the court examined whether the trial court properly applied the “benefits rule” to reduce the damages awarded against the executor for the excessive commission. The benefits rule was established 28 ACTEC Journal 156 (2002) in Nelson v. Krusen, 678 S.W. 2d 918 (Tex. 1984), when the Texas Supreme Court refused to recognize a cause of action for wrongful life and held that the court must offset any special benefits the plaintiff receives resulting from the negligence. In Nelson, the court held that the collateral source rule prevents a tortfeasor from receiving any benefit from payments conferred upon an injured party from sources other than the tortfeasor. In Lee, because the estate tax deduction emanated from a different source than the wrongdoer, the court held that the executor was not entitled to have the surcharge for his excessive commission reduced by the increased estate tax deduction. After an extensive analysis of the benefits rule in which it reviewed decisions of the United States Supreme Court, the Texas appellate courts and courts in other jurisdictions, the court held that the trial court erred in applying the increased tax deduction as an offset to the commission. Although the estate will be enriched by $1.5 million, the court observed that “it is more appropriate for the estate to obtain the benefit of a windfall than to let [the executor] keep $1.5 million in fees the jury found was unreasonable.” Lee, at 780. The court further found that sufficient evidence supported the jury’s finding that $2.2 million was an excessive executor’s commission. The court also passed on various claims for allowance of attorneys’ fees in the litigation in light of its holding that the son should be removed as trustee of the testamentary trust (but not as executor of the estate) because he had committed various breaches of fiduciary duty. The parties stipulated that the fees of the daughter’s and son’s attorneys’ in the trial court were $1.5 million each. The trial court also awarded both parties $300,000 in attorneys’ fees for the appeal to the Court of Appeals and $100,000 if either should seek review by the Texas Supreme Court. On appeal the court held that the trial court erred in refusing to require the son to reimburse the estate for the daughter’s attorneys’ trial court fees and that he also reimburse the trust for the daughter’s attorneys’ appellate court fees paid by the trust. Finally the court held that the son must pay the trust post-judgment interest at 10% per annum compounded annually on the reimbursements for attorneys’ fees. New Developments in Construction and Instruction Case Law compiled by John F. Meck Pittsburgh, Pennsylvania The following case summaries are a project of the Construction and Instruction Subcommittee of the Fiduciary Litigation Committee. The project is intended to update Fellows regarding cases in the instruction and construction area. The committee invites all Fellows to furnish material that would be suitable for inclusion in the column. The material may be sent to any member of the subcommittee.* ALABAMA C. Fred Daniels, Birmingham Traceable proceeds from sale of timber by life tenant with absolute power of disposition belong to remainder beneficiary at life tenant’s death Husband died in 1994. His will left all his property to his wife for her life, “with the absolute power of disposition of all or any part thereof, and upon her death any part of my said estate then remaining” to go to the husband’s descendants. The wife sold timber from the real estate and used the proceeds to purchase certificates of deposit in the names of her daughter and herself as joint tenants with right of survivorship. When the wife died in 1998, her son, who was the executor of her estate, filed a petition to determine the ownership of the certificates of deposit. At common law, a purported life estate coupled with an absolute power of disposition was deemed to be an estate in fee simple absolute, with the result that the remaindermen did not take anything. The common law rule was modified by statute in Alabama to provide that an absolute power of disposition with respect to an estate for life or years that is not in trust remains subject to the future estates limited thereon if the power is not executed or the property is not sold for the satisfaction of debts during the continuance of the particular estate. Ala. Code § 35-4-292(a) (1991 Repl.). Accordingly, a life tenant with absolute power of disposition is free to dispose of the property during his or her lifetime, but any portion of the property remaining at his or her death passes to the remain- * Construction and Instruction Subcommittee: John F. Meck, Chair, Arthur H. Bayern, Clark R. Byam, Gerald L. Cowan, dermen to the extent that it is not disposed of. The Alabama Supreme Court recently interpreted the statute as not being limited to the portion of the estate that remained unchanged in kind or form. Williams v. Burgett, 2002 WL 442718 (Ala.), March 22, 2002. Instead, the proceeds in this case that remained under the power and control of the wife as life tenant remained a part of the life estate and passed to the remaindermen at her death. The daughter as joint tenant with right of survivorship of the certificates of deposit took nothing. One justice who concurred specially noted, however, that the record failed to reflect whether the decedent practiced tree farming and, if so, whether the sale by the wife during her life estate was similar to the timber operations practiced by the husband. He noted that if it was, the life tenant had a right to the proceeds from the timber sale without regard to the power of disposition. The implication is that had the daughter argued that some or all of the proceeds from the cutting of timber were income, that portion might have been freed from the life estate. CALIFORNIA Clark R. Byam, Pasadena Fiduciary Did Not “Transcribe” the Trust A recent California Supreme Court decision affirmed both the trial and Appellate Court’s rulings that California Probate Code section 21350(a) does not include within the class of “persons disqualified” (from inheritance) because they cause an instrument to be transcribed, a fiduciary who provides information needed in the instruments, preparation, and encourages the donor to execute it, but does not direct or otherwise participate in the instrument’s transcription to the final written form. The petitioner, Rice (who was not an heir of decedent), sought to invalidate gifts given by the decedent by a 1995 trust and by other instruments that left the dece- John G. Grimsley, Karen M. Moore. 28 ACTEC Journal 157 (2002) dent’s entire estate to the respondent, Richard Clark, and his wife, on the basis that the transfers to Clark were invalid under section 21350(a)(4), which treats as invalid, an instrument providing donative transfers to “any person who has a fiduciary relationship with the transferor, who transcribes the instrument or causes it to be transcribed.” Clark was in a fiduciary relationship with decedent, having been the trustee of the decedent’s trust prior to her death, and was the recipient of the entire trust estate upon decedent’s death. The trial court concluded that in order to be deemed to have caused an instrument to be transcribed, within the meaning of section 21350(a)(4), the recipient had to be “substantially, and uninterruptedly, [involved in] the writing down, or causing to be printed, the words of another.” The trial court noted that while Clark had arranged for the preparation of the challenged documents, he neither drafted the instruments, transcribed them, or caused them to be transcribed because “he did none of the thinking or writing himself nor did he order or request any other person to do so.” This decision will make it much more difficult to challenge donative transfers to fiduciaries under Probate Code section 21350(a)(4), unless the fiduciary was actively involved in the actual transcribing of the document. Otherwise, contestants will be left to the common law cause of action based on undue influence. children and Wife’s to her children, with the joint property to be divided between the two sets of children at the survivor’s death. Prior to execution of the wills, the attorney suggested Husband and Wife execute a post- nuptial agreement or a joint will to acknowledge the oral agreement, but Husband and Wife declined because “each had great confidence in the other.” Subsequent to Wife’s death, Husband executed a new will leaving everything, including the previously joint property, to his children. After Husband’s death, Wife’s children sued to enforce the oral agreement reflected in the original wills. The trial court granted summary judgment to the children. On appeal, the court noted that the mere execution of a joint will or of mutual and reciprocal wills raises no presumption of a contract not to change the wills. The mutual and reciprocal wills remain totally ambulatory. In this instance, however, the original wills clearly stated there was an oral agreement and the wills reflected the terms of the agreement. Accordingly, there was a contract not to revoke as required by Section 474.155, RSMo 1994: KANSAS Calvin J. Karlin, Lawrence Moran v. Kessler, 41 S.W.3d 530 (Mo.App. W.D. 2001). Will Construed to Qualify for Marital Deduction Declaratory judgment statute was used to construe decedent’s will to preserve marital deduction where 365 day survival period was required for spouse. Kansas statute allowing construction of wills to bring them into conformity with federal estate tax statute on marital deduction permitted construction of will to include 60 day survival period (although decedent had crossed out the 60 day provisions and replaced them with 365 day provisions). In re Estate of Keller, 46 P.3d 1135 (Kan. May 31, 2002). MISSOURI Clifford S. Brown, Springfield Mutual and Reciprocal Wills Remain Revocable Absent a Contract Not to Change Husband and Wife executed mutual and reciprocal wills in which each acknowledged an oral agreement as to the ultimate disposition of their estate to their respective children from prior marriages. The agreement was that Husband’s property would go to his 28 ACTEC Journal 158 (2002) “A contract…not to revoke a will… can be established…by (1) Provisions of a will stating material provisions of the contract;” NEVADA Layne T. Rushforth, Las Vegas Unilateral Gift of Homesteaded Residence Void The case of Besnilian v. Wilkinson, 117 Nev. Adv. Op. No. 45, 25 P.3d 187, 2001 Nev. LEXIS 45 (June 21, 2001) involved residential real property that was purchased in joint tenancy by a husband and wife in 1975. In 1990, the couple signed a joint declaration of homestead. The husband subsequently signed a deed in an attempt to convey his one-half undivided interest as a gift. The ruling turned on language in Article 4, Section 30 of the Nevada Constitution, which states that a homestead “shall not be alienated without the joint consent of husband and wife when that relation exists.” One justice dissented stating that the ruling stands for the proposition that homesteading joint tenancy property converts it into community property. [Editorial comment: In reference to the conversion of joint tenancy property into community property, the dissenting judge stated, “I do not find any indication of this intent in Nevada law.” None of the justices took notice that NRS 115.061—a law that was in effect in 1990 when the homestead declaration was signed—provides that a married couple’s homestead declaration converts the ownership into “community property with a right of survivorship”. Obviously, none of the attorneys involved in the case had read that statute, either.] TEXAS Prof. Gerry W. Beyer, San Antonio WILLS – Restraint on Alienation Rather than create a trust, Testator devised real property to his children. The devise provided that if any child wanted to sell his or her share to someone other than Testator’s siblings, the written consent of all of the surviving siblings was required. After all sib- lings die, however, children may sell to anyone, but the descendants of siblings will have a right of first refusal. Two of the children conveyed their interests to third parties without obtaining the prior consent. The remaining children sued to set aside the sales for violating the terms of the devise. The trial court granted summary judgment in favor of the selling children. The appellate court affirmed. The provision requiring Testator’s siblings to approve a sale is a restraint on alienation which is against public policy and thus not enforceable. The court rejected the claim that the Will merely created rights of first refusal. Only after all of Testator’s siblings are deceased does the Will impose a right of first refusal on siblings’ descendants. Williams v. Williams, 73 S.W.3d 376 (Tex. App.—Houston [1st Dist.] 2002, no pet. h.). A person wishing to impose restrictions on alienation should consider a trust or other techniques. 28 ACTEC Journal 159 (2002) ACTech Talk: Tips for Technophobes by Robert B. Fleming Tucson, Arizona You may be one of the growing minority (but still minority) of lawyers who loves to experiment with and implement technological approaches to problem-solving in your law office. You may even be inclined to try out a high-tech “solution” for problems that haven’t yet proven to need solutions at all. If, however, you are like most lawyers, your attitude may be that you would rather practice law than play with “toys.” You may believe that you haven’t the time or inclination to pursue questionable and ultimately unreliable approaches to the practice. Do not misunderstand our emphasis—we are committed technology partisans, and we are proud of our high-tech toys (though we object to anyone else characterizing them as such, since we really do see them as tools to help us in the practice of law). We acknowledge, however, that there is still a significant segment of the practicing bar that proudly proclaims a complete inability to manage or deal with computers. We have seen and heard more than one Fellow, chest puffed, announce that he (usually) knows where the on/off switch is located but absolutely nothing else about the paperweight placed on the Fellow’s desk by the firm’s managing partner. We firmly believe that such technophobia is professionally limiting. But we also recognize that the technology can be daunting, and that its first creative use can be the most difficult. Accordingly, we offer a handful of specific tips for Fellows suffering from technophobia. We do not mean to suggest that each of these can be implemented by the technologically backward; some or all will require the participation of support staff and even the MIS (Management Information Systems—the modern euphemism for professional nerds) Department. In publishing this list we hope to accomplish two entirely separate goals. First, we hope that some of the more open-minded Luddites among our membership will see an opportunity to utilize technology in discrete, relatively painless ways—possibly leading (who knows?) to more extensive use of technology in the future. Second, we hope to entertain those who are more technologically advanced, reassuring them that they know more than they think and (who knows?) maybe even suggest a few new ideas to that group. Herewith a handful of tips for technophobes—or for those merely aspiring to technophobia: 28 ACTEC Journal 160 (2002) Digital Photographs of Clients You should be able to see most or all of the work product associated with a given client or file in one place on your computer. You may even be able to find the list of files using a document (or information) management program like Worldox, or iManage. Even if you are limited to the simple approach of using Windows Explorer, you probably already know how to get to the files for a particular client or case. But can you see a picture of your client(s) in that directory? Wouldn’t it be nice if, while working on Mr. and Mrs. Jones’ estate plan, you could remind yourself what they look like—and perhaps even recall the substance of their office consultation two weeks ago? When Mr. Jones calls to suggest some minor changes, or to inquire how long before drafts will arrive, wouldn’t it be nice to be able to call up his picture and put face to name while you talk to him on the phone? If you occasionally go to court, wouldn’t it be an advantage to be able to remind yourself what your clients look like before searching for them in a crowded courtroom? This technological advance is easy for the technophobe, and relatively inexpensive. It requires no action on his or her part except to direct implementation. Buy the office a small handheld digital camera (one of us uses a Canon PowerShot A20, which currently lists for about $340—but completely acceptable models can be found for $200 or so) and hand it to the receptionist. Ask him or her to take a picture of every new client, and any long-time client whose picture is not already in the (electronic) file. The receptionist may initially balk, but will probably find the exercise entertaining and a pleasant way to establish rapport with clients. In case you are worried about file size (feel free to skip this paragraph if you are not), a reasonably clear picture should be in the 200-300 kilobyte range. With hard drive sizes and prices where they are today, that additional storage requirement will be inconsequential. The draft of your revocable trust will be nearly as large, and the scanned copy of the signed trust two or three times larger. In other words, the size and number of files on your computer network is simply not an issue at present. In addition to helping remind you what your clients look like, a number of ancillary benefits flow from regularly photographing them as you do their work. In our experience clients will be pleased that you are helping to prevent any future instances of fraud. Many will have heard of digital cameras, but not seen them in use; most will not have seen pictures of themselves captured digitally (we always print a copy to hand to the client, since we received so many requests when first implementing this project). You will also have created a record of the client’s appearance at about the time of signing important documents in most cases, which may help reduce the prospect of later challenges (though with inadequate or poorly arranged lighting, clients may actually look more haggard and less competent than they appear in real life). Finally, you will have reassured clients that no one else can appear, claiming to be them, and confuse or frustrate their estate plans. Working from Home Almost everyone professes to be interested in working at least part time from home, or from a summer cabin, Tahiti or the Rive Gauche. Turns out it’s easy to accomplish. If your remote location includes access to a web browser, you can launch your office desktop computer with a modest investment and even more modest technological skills. The easy way to get access to your office computer from elsewhere is to use GoToMyPC (www.gotomypc.com). Installation is simple; first browse out to the website from your office computer and install the software. Cost is a mere $19.95 per month, with unlimited access. Costs are even lower if you pay for a year at a time (that reduces the cost to $14.95 per month) or enroll two or more computers. There is even a thirtyday free “test drive” option. While installing you will be prompted for an e-mail address, a password for the program and another, separate password for each computer to be shared. Once GoToMyPC is installed on your office computer, you will see a small icon in that computer’s system tray (don’t worry if you don’t know what that means—you don’t have to see it or do anything with it to make the program work). Now you simply log into www.gotomypc.com from any other computer, enter your e-mail address and the two passwords you provided, and voila (assuming you are actually on the Rive Gauche), you are looking at your office computer remotely. This method of accessing your office is simple and inexpensive, though there are two caveats: (1) your MIS department (if you have one) may want to have a say in letting you do this, and (2) the link is immensely more useful if you have high-speed internet access (DSL, cable or other non-dialup type access) at both ends of the connection. With the increasingly widespread availability of high-speed access, however, this remote computing approach can give you incredible flexibility. PDAs (Personal Digital Assistants) All right—this is a song we have sung before. Palm or PocketPC handheld computing devices are capable of changing your professional life. Carry your calendar everywhere without having to rely on staff to update a paper version every day. Enter new contact information while at a seminar, a cocktail party or a court hearing. Schedule a new court hearing and have it automatically show up on your office calendar when you return. Maintain, update and complete your list of ToDo items during your commute (assuming you do not drive), on an airplane or while waiting for your car to get washed. We often see three roadblocks to the widespread use of PDAs by Fellows. Some like the idea, but can not decide which PDA they should buy. Some can get past that problem, but are worried that installation and management will be too difficult to figure out. And some—perhaps most—are simply uncertain whether the handheld device will prove to be valuable. As to the last of those problems, you may just have to take our word for it. The good news: if you buy the least expensive PDA on the market, you can try a $100 (or less) experiment. If you are sold, but decide you need a more capable unit, your teenage child will love the hand-me-down PDA while you go out to upgrade. Working backwards through the problem list, installation may indeed require the intervention of a technical expert. We suggest relying on your secretary, or that same teenager, to get the unit installed and connected to your office’s calendar and case management system. Know in advance that it is astonishingly easy to use Microsoft Outlook, Time Matters, Amicus Attorney or any of the widely-used case management/calendaring systems with PDAs, though there is some difference in how well each program relates to the two main types of handheld. Now for the hardest question: which unit should you try? If you are a Microsoft Outlook user, and especially if you are also a Microsoft Office user, purchase a PocketPC unit. Otherwise, look at one of the many Palm-powered units. The choices are myriad, but the good news is that at these prices, it is hard to make a bad choice. Deciding which Palm-type unit you want/need is dependent on the answer to two questions: (1) do you need a color screen? And (2) do you want to combine your Palm with your cell phone? If the answer to both those questions is negative, start with a Palm m105, a Handspring Visor Platinum, or a Sony Clie PEG-SL10. These basic machines will give you an introduction to the genre, and cost less than $150 each. 28 ACTEC Journal 161 (2002) Why would you need color? There is one major advantage—the color screens provide better contrast and are easier for middle-aged eyes to read. The tradeoffs, of course, are cost and battery life, but neither suffers so much that it makes the investment in color foolish. Palm, Handspring and Clio (the main competitors in this market) each make a collection of color options—choose one and give it a try, knowing that you can always trade out for another model and your spouse or child(ren) will be delighted with their new PDA(s). The latest development in the PDA market, though, is the notion of convergent technology—combining a Palm with a cell phone. There are three major competitors for this market, and each has its partisans. You will have a hard time making a mistake here, and so you should probably start by contacting your cell phone carrier to see which unit it offers, and at what (discounted) price. In a general way, the Samsung SPH-I300 is best described as a PDA with cell-phone capabilities, the Kyocera 7135 as a cell phone with a built-in PDA, and the Handspring Treo 300 as a compromise between the two (though the Treo uses a thumb-operated keyboard exclusively, which may make it harder to utilize than the handwriting-based input on other PDAs). For our money the Kyocera 7135 looks like the early winner, but all three are excellent choices. Multiple Monitors Okay—this one takes a little more technical expertise to set up, but the payoff is definitely worth it. You probably have a growing collection of used monitors 28 ACTEC Journal 162 (2002) sitting around the office—castoffs as staffers upgrade to LCD panels, or at least to larger monitors. Grab one of those, clear some desk space and set it next to your existing monitor. Now get someone to connect it to your computer (it will probably require a second video display card, but that need not cost more than about $30-50). The benefits are amazing. With two monitors, you can have your case management program open on one screen at all times. Your calendar, or your list of clients and contacts, can be immediately available even while your word processor is open on an active document. Or you can have two separate word processing documents open, and cut and paste between them without having to switch screens (or shrink either document to an unreadable size). Or your e-mail can be always-on, letting you know at a glance when you are outbid on eBay. If your desk (the real one, not the virtual one) is small and/or cluttered already, it may be difficult to find space for a second monitor. In that case, or if you have lots of extra monitors looking for homes, try installing the second monitor at your assistant’s workstation. We predict that he or she will love the new flexibility it affords. These relatively simple ideas are useful no matter how technologically adept you may be. You may have others, and if so we would love to hear from you. Email your ideas to [email protected] or [email protected]. If we use your tips in a future column, we just might send you one of our leftover monitors, or PDAs. On the other hand, we both have children and spouses. New Developments in Malpractice compiled by Keith Bradoc Gallant, New Haven, Connecticut and Sharon B. Gardner, Houston, Texas The Malpractice Subcommittee of the Fiduciary Litigation Committee has initiated a new project to help keep Fellows current on issues that are relevant to their practice area. The following cases summarize opinions from several states published in 2002 in the ethics and malpractice areas. Some opinions have not yet been finalized or published. All Fellows are requested to provide any cases from their respective jurisdictions that may be suitable for this column. Any Fellow of the subcommittee will be glad to receive a submission.1 MARYLAND Privity United States further reasoned because Murphy had no standing individually, the damages recovered inured solely to the benefit of the estate. The court of appeals, in considering the summary judgment filed by the United States, reasoned that Maryland follows a strict privity rule in causes of action for malpractice against an attorney. Maryland has a narrow third party beneficiary theory, but the exception requires allegation and proof that the intent of the client to benefit the nonclient was a direct purpose of the transaction. The central question before the court of appeals was whether, as an individual, Murphy had standing to sue Hackney either because of an employment relationship with Hackney or because, as primary beneficiary under Mrs. Murphy’s will, he was the intended third party beneficiary of Hackney’s legal services to the Estate. At the hearing, Murphy did not offer evidence to support that Mrs. Murphy’s primary purpose in engaging Hackney for legal services was to benefit Murphy as the primary beneficiary of her estate. The court noted there was no retainer agreement and held that Murphy had failed to produce sufficient evidence that Murphy had standing to sue Hackney as primary beneficiary of the Estate. Accordingly, the settlement proceeds constituted Estate property to which the United States has a superior claim because of its tax lien. The summary judgment for the United States was granted. Murphy v. Comptroller of the Treasury, 207 F. Supp. 2d 400 (D. Md.) Murphy brought an interpleader action to determine his entitlement to $130,460.20. The amount represented settlement proceeds recovered by Murphy for alleged malpractice committed by Hackney for negligently valuing the Estate’s assets and computing the Estate’s tax liability. Murphy alleged Hackney’s malpractice conduct resulted in a substantial assessment of taxes, penalties and interest against the Estate. Murphy and the United States each argued that they have a superior claim to some or all of the settlement proceeds. The opinion notes that on September 9, 1993, the IRS assessed taxes totaling $292,199.00 against the Estate. As of January 14, 2002, the Estate owed the IRS $1,271,800.98 in estate taxes, penalties and interest. The Estate also owed the State of Maryland $33,377.41. The United States and the State of Maryland had placed a tax lien on the estate property. Murphy argued that he had a superior claim to a portion of the settlement proceeds because of the dual capacity in which he brought the malpractice suit. The suit was brought by Murphy individually and as a copersonal representative of the estate. The United States argued that it had a superior claim to all of the settlement proceeds because of the federal tax lien against the estate. The United States further alleged that under Maryland law Murphy did not have standing to sue Hackney in an individual capacity for damages. The Leak-Gilbert v. Fahle, 2002 WL1753198 (Ok. 2002) (not yet released for publication) In 1997, Mr. Leak hired Fahle to update his will. Mr. Leak provided a copy of his current will to Fahle and asked that his grandson be disinherited. Fahle indicated that Mr. Leak identified his only heirs as the children of a deceased son, Alvin Troy Leak, Alvin James Leak, and the Plaintiffs in this matter. After Mr. Leak’s death in 1999, the will was submitted for probate. The proceedings revealed that Mr. Leak had four additional grandchildren by another deceased son. Those grandchildren were not mentioned in the will. Consequently, the probate court treated the grandchildren as unintentionally omitted Members of the subcommittee include Woody Davis, Ed Downey, Brad Gallant, Sharon Gardner, Charles Gibbs, Rodney Houghton, Ron Link, Peter Matwiczyk, John Price, and Judith Seigel-Baum. 1 OKLAHOMA 28 ACTEC Journal 163 (2002) heirs, and it divided the estate among the grandchildren as if the decedent had died interstate. The beneficiaries of the will brought a legal malpractice action against Fahle, asserting that she was negligent, and that she had breached the contract with the decedent because she failed to properly prepare his will according to his intentions. Apparently, Fahle’s sister was a lawyer and had probated the will of another deceased family member, where the grandchildren may or may not have been named. Fahle admitted her sister may have handled the probate of the decedent’s wife, but Fahle and her sister never practiced law together and those files were maintained in storage. Fahle claimed she had no affirmative duty to locate additional heirs beyond what Mr. Leak told her at their consultation The Oklahoma Supreme Court was asked to answer questions of law from the Western District of Oklahoma: 1) whether, in the absence of a specific request by the client, an attorney owes a duty to the client or to the beneficiaries named in the client’s will to conduct an investigation into the client’s heirs independent of, or in addition to, the information provided by the client; and 2) whether the residual beneficiaries under a decedent’s will have a cause of action for legal malpractice against the attorney who drafted the will under a theory of negligence or breach of contract when the will fails to identify all the decedent’s heirs? The Oklahoma Supreme Court held that when an attorney is retained to prepare a will, the attorney’s duty to prepare the will according to the testator’s wishes does not ordinarily include an investigation of a client’s heirs independent of, or in addition to, the information provided by the client, unless the client requests such an investigation; and 2) an intended will beneficiary may maintain a legal malpractice action under either negligence or contract theories against the drafter when the will fails to identify all the decedent’s heirs as a result of the attorney’s substandard professional performance. This decision is a case of first impression in Oklahoma. Volume 28, No. 2, Fall 2002 ACTEC JOURNAL Published quarterly for the Fellows of The American College of Trust and Estate Counsel as a professional service. Members of the College receive a subscription to ACTEC Journal without charge. Nonmembers may subscribe to ACTEC Journal for $60 per year. Price for single issue, if available, is $15 per issue. This publication contains articles that express various opinions. The opinions expressed in such articles are those of the authors and do not necessarily reflect the opinion of the College. Correspondence with respect to College business may be addressed to Executive Director, The American College of Trust and Estate Counsel, 3415 S. Sepulveda Boulevard, Suite 330, Los Angeles, California 90034. Telephone: (310) 398-1888. Fax: (310) 572-7280. Web site: www.actec.org. 28 ACTEC Journal 164 (2002)